blob: a8ba58a902ae180c516c0e3327422dd753ba3180 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaufc0b8f32020-05-05 21:49:10 +02007 2020/05/05
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100604 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100607 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100609 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200610 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200612 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200613 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - presetenv
616 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - uid
618 - ulimit-n
619 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200620 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100621 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-options
627 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200628 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-options
630 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100631 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200632 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100633 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100634 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100635 - 51degrees-data-file
636 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200637 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200638 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-data-file
640 - wurfl-information-list
641 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100643 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100646 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200647 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200649 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100650 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100651 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200653 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200654 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200655 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200656 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - noepoll
658 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000659 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100661 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300662 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000663 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100664 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200665 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200666 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200667 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000668 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000669 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200670 - tune.buffers.limit
671 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200672 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200673 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100674 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200675 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200676 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200677 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100678 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200679 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200680 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100681 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100682 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100683 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100684 - tune.lua.session-timeout
685 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200686 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100687 - tune.maxaccept
688 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200689 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200690 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200691 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100692 - tune.rcvbuf.client
693 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100694 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200695 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100696 - tune.sndbuf.client
697 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100698 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100699 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200700 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100701 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200702 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200703 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100704 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200705 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100706 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200707 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
708 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
709 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100710 - tune.zlib.memlevel
711 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100712
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713 * Debugging
714 - debug
715 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200716 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200717
718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007193.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720------------------------------------
721
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200722ca-base <dir>
723 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100724 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
725 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
726 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200727
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200728chroot <jail dir>
729 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
730 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
731 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
732 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
733 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100734 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100735
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100736cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
737 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
738 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
739 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
740 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
741 set. These sets have the format
742
743 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
744
745 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100746 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100747 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
748 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100749 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
750 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100752 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100753 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100754 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100755 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
756 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
757 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
758 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100759
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100760 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
761 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
762 on the machine's word size.
763
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100764 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100765 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
766 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
767 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
768 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
769 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
770 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771
772 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100773 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
774
775 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
776 # first 4 CPUs
777
778 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
779 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
780 # word size.
781
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100782 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100783 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100784 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
786 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
787
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100788 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
789 # and so on.
790 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
791 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
792 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
793
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100794 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100795 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
796 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
797 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
798
799 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
800 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
801 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
802
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100803 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
804 # and a thread range.
805 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
806 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
808
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200809crt-base <dir>
810 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100811 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
812 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200813
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200814daemon
815 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
816 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100817 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
818 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200820deviceatlas-json-file <path>
821 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100822 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200823
824deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100825 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
827
828deviceatlas-separator <char>
829 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
830 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
831
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100832deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200833 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
834 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
835 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100836
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900837external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100838 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
839 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100840 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
841 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
842 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
843 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
844 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900845
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846gid <number>
847 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
848 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
849 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100850 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
851 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200852 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100853
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100854group <group name>
855 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
856 See also "gid" and "user".
857
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100858hard-stop-after <time>
859 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
860
861 Arguments :
862 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
863 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
864 SIGUSR1 signal.
865
866 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
867 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
868 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
869
870 Example:
871 global
872 hard-stop-after 30s
873
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200874h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
875 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
876 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
877 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
878 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500879 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200880 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
881 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
882 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
883 specified in a proxy.
884
885 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
886 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
887 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
888 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
889 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
890 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
891 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
892
893 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
894 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
895 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
896 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
897 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
898
899 Example:
900 global
901 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
902
903 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
904 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
905
906h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
907 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
908 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
909 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
910 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
911 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
912 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
913 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
914 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
915
916 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
917 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
918 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
919
920 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
921 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
922
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100923insecure-fork-wanted
924 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
925 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
926 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
927 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
928 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
929 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
930 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
931 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
932 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
933 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
934 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
935 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
936 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
937 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
938 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
939 disable it.
940
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100941insecure-setuid-wanted
942 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
943 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
944 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
945 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
946 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
947 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
948 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
949 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
950 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
951 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
952 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
953 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
954 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
955 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
956
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100957issuers-chain-path <dir>
958 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
959 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
960 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
961 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
962 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
963 "issuers-chain-path".
964 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
965 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
966 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
967 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
968 will share the chain in memory.
969
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200970log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
971 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100972 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100973 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100974 configured with "log global".
975
976 <address> can be one of:
977
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100978 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100979 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
980 port).
981
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100982 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
983 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
984 port).
985
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100986 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100987 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
988 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100989 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100990
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100991 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
992 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
993 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
994 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
995 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
996 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
997 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
998 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
999 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1000 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1001 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1002 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1003 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1004 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001005 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1006 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001007
1008 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1009 "fd@2", see above.
1010
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001011 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1012 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1013 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1014 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1015 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1016
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001017 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1018 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001019
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001020 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1021 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1022 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1023 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1024 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1025 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1026 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1027 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1028 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1029 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001030 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1031 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001032
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001033 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1034 one of the following :
1035
1036 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1037 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1038
1039 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1040 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1041
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001042 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1043 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1044 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1045 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1046 logger consumes.
1047
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001048 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1049 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1050 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1051 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1052
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001053 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1054 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1055 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1056 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1057 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1058
1059 <sample_size>
1060 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1061 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1062 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1063 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1064 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1065
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001066 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001067
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001068 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1069 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1070 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1071
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001072 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1073 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1074 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1075 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
1077 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001078 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1079 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1080 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1081 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1082 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1083 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001085 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001086
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001087log-send-hostname [<string>]
1088 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1089 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1090 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1091 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1092 the logs.
1093
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001094log-tag <string>
1095 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1096 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1097 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001098 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001099
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001100lua-load <file>
1101 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1102 used multiple times.
1103
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001104lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1105 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1106 variable.
1107 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1108 to "path".
1109
1110 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1111 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1112 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1113 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1114 will be checked earlier.
1115
1116 As an example by specifying the following path:
1117
1118 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1119 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1120
1121 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1122 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1123 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1124 paths if that does not exist either.
1125
1126 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1127 documentation.
1128
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001129master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001130 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1131 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1132 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001133 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001134 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1135 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001136 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1137 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1138 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1139 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1140 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001141
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001142 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001143
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001144mworker-max-reloads <number>
1145 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001146 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001147 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1148 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1149 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1150
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001151nbproc <number>
1152 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1153 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1154 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001155 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1156 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001157 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1158 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001160nbthread <number>
1161 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001162 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1163 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1164 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1165 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1166 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001167 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1168 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1169 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1170 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1171 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1172 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1173 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001174
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001175pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001176 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1178 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1179
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001180presetenv <name> <value>
1181 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1182 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1183 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1184 and "unsetenv".
1185
1186resetenv [<name> ...]
1187 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1188 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1189 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1190 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1191 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1192 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1193 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1194 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1195
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001196stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001197 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1198 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1199 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1200 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1201 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1202 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001203 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001204 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1205 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1206 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1207 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001208
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001209server-state-base <directory>
1210 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001211 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1212 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001213
1214server-state-file <file>
1215 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1216 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1217 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1218 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1219 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1220 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1221 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1222 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001223 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1224 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001225
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001226setenv <name> <value>
1227 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1228 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1229 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1230 and "unsetenv".
1231
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001232set-dumpable
1233 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001234 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1235 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1236 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1237 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1238 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1239 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1240 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1241 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1242 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1243 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1244 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1245 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1246 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1247 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1248 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1249 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1250 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001251
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001252ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1254 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001255 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001256 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001257 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1258 information and recommendations see e.g.
1259 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1260 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1261 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1262 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001263
1264ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1266 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1267 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1268 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1269 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001270 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1271 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1272 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001273 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001274
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001275ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1277 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1278 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1279 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1280 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1281
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001282ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1284 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1285 keyword to see available options.
1286
1287 Example:
1288 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001289 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001290
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001291ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1293 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001294 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001295 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001296 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1297 information and recommendations see e.g.
1298 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1299 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1300 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1301 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1302 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001303
1304ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1306 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1307 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1308 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1309 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001310 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1311 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1312 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1313 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001314
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001315ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1317 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1318 keyword to see available options.
1319
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001320ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1322 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1323 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001324 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001325 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001326 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1327 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1328 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1329 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001330 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1331 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1332 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1333
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001334ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001335 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1336 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1337
1338 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1339 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1340 optimize the startup time.
1341
1342 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1343 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1344 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1345
1346 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001347 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001348
1349 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1350 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1351 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1352 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1353 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1354 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001355 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001356 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1357
1358 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1359
1360 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1361
1362 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1363 not provided in the PEM file.
1364
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001365 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1366 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1367
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001368 The default behavior is "all".
1369
1370 Example:
1371 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1372 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1373 ssl-load-extra-files none
1374
1375 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1376
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001377ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1378 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1379 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1380 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1381
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001382ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1383 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1384 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1385 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1386 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1387 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1388 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1389 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1390 bits does not need it.
1391
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001392stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1393 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1394 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1395 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001396 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001397 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001398
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001399 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1400 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1401 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001402
1403stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1404 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1405 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001406 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001407
1408stats maxconn <connections>
1409 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1410 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1411
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001412uid <number>
1413 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1414 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1415 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1416 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1417
1418ulimit-n <number>
1419 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1420 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1421 option.
1422
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001423unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1424 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1425
1426 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1427 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1428 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1429 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1430 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1431 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1432 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1433 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1434 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1435 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1436
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001437unsetenv [<name> ...]
1438 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1439 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1440 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1441 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1442 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1443 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1444 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1445
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001446user <user name>
1447 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1448 See also "uid" and "group".
1449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001450node <name>
1451 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1452
1453 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1454 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1455 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1456 traffic.
1457
1458description <text>
1459 Add a text that describes the instance.
1460
1461 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1462 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1463 "<" and ">" characters.
1464
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100146551degrees-data-file <file path>
1466 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001467 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001468
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001469 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001470 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1471
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000147251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001473 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1474 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1475 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1476
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001477 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001478 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1479
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200148051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001481 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1482 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1483
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001484 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1485 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1486
148751degrees-cache-size <number>
1488 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1489 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1490 By default, this cache is disabled.
1491
1492 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001493 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1494
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001495wurfl-data-file <file path>
1496 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1497 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1498
1499 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1500 with USE_WURFL=1.
1501
1502wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1503 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1504 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1505 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1506
1507 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1508
1509 Valid WURFL properties are:
1510 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1511
1512 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1513 device.
1514
1515 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1516 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1517
1518 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1519 particular web request.
1520
1521 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1522 used Libwurfl API version.
1523
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001524 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1525 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1526
1527 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1528 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1529
1530 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1531
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001532 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1533 with USE_WURFL=1.
1534
1535wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1536 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1537 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1538
1539 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1540 with USE_WURFL=1.
1541
1542wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1543 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1544 thus before the chroot.
1545
1546 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1547 with USE_WURFL=1.
1548
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001549wurfl-cache-size <size>
1550 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1551 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001552 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001553 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001554
1555 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1556 with USE_WURFL=1.
1557
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001558strict-limits
1559 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1560 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1561 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1562 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1563 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1564 keyword.
1565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015663.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001567-----------------------
1568
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001569busy-polling
1570 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1571 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1572 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1573 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1574 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1575 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1576 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1577 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1578 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1579 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1580 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1581 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1582 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1583 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1584 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1585 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1586 "poll" pollers.
1587
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001588 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1589 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1590 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1591
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001592max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1593 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1594 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1595 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1596 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1597 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1598 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1599 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1600 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1601
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001602maxconn <number>
1603 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1604 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1605 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001606 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1607 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1608 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1609 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001610 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1611 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1612 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1613 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1614 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1615 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001616
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001617maxconnrate <number>
1618 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1619 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1620 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1621 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1622 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1623 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1624 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1625 fairness.
1626
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001627maxcomprate <number>
1628 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001629 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001630 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1631 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1632 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001633 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001634 default value.
1635
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001636maxcompcpuusage <number>
1637 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1638 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1639 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1640 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1641 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1642 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1643 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1644 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1645
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001646maxpipes <number>
1647 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1648 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1649 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1650 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1651 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1652 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1653
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001654maxsessrate <number>
1655 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1656 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1657 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1658 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1659 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1660 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1661 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1662 fairness.
1663
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001664maxsslconn <number>
1665 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1666 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1667 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1668 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1669 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1670 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1671 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001672 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1673 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1674 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1675 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1676 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1677 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1678 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001679
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001680maxsslrate <number>
1681 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1682 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1683 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1684 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1685 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1686 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1687 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1688 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1689 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1690 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1691
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001692maxzlibmem <number>
1693 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1694 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1695 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001696 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1697 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1698 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001700noepoll
1701 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1702 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001703 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001704
1705nokqueue
1706 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1707 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1708 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1709
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001710noevports
1711 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1712 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1713 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1714 also "nopoll".
1715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001716nopoll
1717 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1718 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001720 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1721 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001722
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001723nosplice
1724 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001725 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001726 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001727 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001728 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1729 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1730 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1731 "option splice-response".
1732
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001733nogetaddrinfo
1734 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1735 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1736
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001737noreuseport
1738 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1739 command line argument "-dR".
1740
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001741profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1742 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1743 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1744 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1745 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001746 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001747 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1748 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1749 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1750 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1751
1752 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1753 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1754 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1755 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1756 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001757 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1758 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1759 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1760 CLI.
1761
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001762spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001763 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1764 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1765 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1766 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1767 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1768 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001770ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001771 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001772 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001773 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1774 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1775 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1776 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1777 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001778 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1779 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001780 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1781 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1782 openssl configuration file uses:
1783 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1784
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001785ssl-mode-async
1786 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001787 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001788 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1789 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1790 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001791 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001792 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001793
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001794tune.buffers.limit <number>
1795 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1796 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1797 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1798 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1799 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001800 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001801 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1802 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1803 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1804 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1805 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1806 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1807 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1808 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1809 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1810
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001811tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1812 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1813 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1814 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1815 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1816
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001817tune.bufsize <number>
1818 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1819 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1820 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1821 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1822 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1823 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1824 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001825 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1826 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1827 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001828 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001829 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1830 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1831 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001832
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001833tune.chksize <number>
1834 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1835 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1836 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1837 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1838 checks whenever possible.
1839
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001840tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1841 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1842 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1843 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1844 this value. The default value is 1.
1845
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001846tune.fail-alloc
1847 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1848 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1849 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1850 gracefully.
1851
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001852tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1853 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1854 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1855 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1856 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1857 change it.
1858
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001859tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1860 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001861 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1862 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001863 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1864 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1865 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1866 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1867 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1868
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001869tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1870 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1871 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1872 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1873 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1874 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1875 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1876 recommended not to change this value.
1877
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001878tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1879 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1880 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1881 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1882 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1883 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1884 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1885 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1886
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001887tune.http.cookielen <number>
1888 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1889 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1890 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1891 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1892 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1893 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1894 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1895 to change this value.
1896
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001897tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001898 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1899 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001900 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001901 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001902 configuration directives too.
1903 The default value is 1024.
1904
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001905tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1906 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1907 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1908 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1909 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1910 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1911 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001912 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1913 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1914 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001915
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001916tune.idletimer <timeout>
1917 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1918 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1919 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1920 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1921 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1922 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001923 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001924 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001925 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1926
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001927tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1928 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1929 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1930 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1931 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1932 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1933 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1934 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1935 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1936 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1937
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001938tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1939 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001940 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001941 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1942 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001943 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001944 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1945 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1946
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001947tune.lua.maxmem
1948 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1949 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1950 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1951 memory.
1952
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001953tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1954 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001955 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1956 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001957 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001958
1959tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1960 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1961 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1962 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1963 check servers.
1964
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001965tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1966 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1967 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1968 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001969 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001970
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001971tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001972 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1973 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1974 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1975 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1976 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1977 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1978 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1979 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1980 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1981 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001982
1983tune.maxpollevents <number>
1984 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1985 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1986 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1987 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1988 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1989
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001990tune.maxrewrite <number>
1991 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1992 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1993 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1994 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1995 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1996 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1997 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1998 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1999 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2000 bufsize.
2001
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002002tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2003 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2004 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2005 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2006 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2007 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2008 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2009 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2010 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2011 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002012 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2013 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002014 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2015 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2016 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2017 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2018 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2019 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2020 setting this parameter to 0.
2021
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002022tune.pipesize <number>
2023 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2024 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2025 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2026 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2027 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2028 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2029
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002030tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2031 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2032 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2033 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2034 default is 20.
2035
2036tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2037 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2038 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2039 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2040 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2041 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2042 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002043 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002044
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002045tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2046tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2047 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2048 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2049 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002050 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002051 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002052 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2053 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2054
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002055tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002056 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002057 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2058 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2059 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2060 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2061
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002062tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002063 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002064 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2065 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2066
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002067tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2068tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2069 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2070 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2071 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002072 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002073 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002074 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2075 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2076 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2077 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2078 notifying haproxy again.
2079
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002080tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002081 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2082 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2083 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002084 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002085 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002086 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002087 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2088 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2089 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002090 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2091 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002092
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002093tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002094 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002095 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2096 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2097 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2098 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2099 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2100
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002101tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2102 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002103 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002104 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2105 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2106 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2107 being used for too long.
2108
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002109tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2110 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2111 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2112 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2113 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2114 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2115 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2116 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2117 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2118 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2119 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002120 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002121 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002122
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002123tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2124 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2125 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2126 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2127 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002128 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002129 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2130 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002131 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2132 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002133
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002134tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2135 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2136 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2137 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2138 1000 entries.
2139
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002140tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2141 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2142 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2143 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2144
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002145tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002146tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002147tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2148tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2149tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002150 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2151 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2152 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2153 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2154 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2155 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2156 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2157 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002158
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002159 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2160 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2161 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2162 all available space is consumed.
2163 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2164 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2165 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002166
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002167tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2168 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002169 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002170 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002171 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002172 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2173
2174tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2175 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2176 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002177 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2178 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021803.3. Debugging
2181--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002182
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002183debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002184 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2185 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2186 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2187 system startup.
2188
2189quiet
2190 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2191 line argument "-q".
2192
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002193zero-warning
2194 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2195 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2196 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2197 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2198 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2199 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2200
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002201
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022023.4. Userlists
2203--------------
2204It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2205http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2206it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2207
2208userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002209 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002210 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2211
2212group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002213 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002214 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2215 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2216
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002217user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2218 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002219 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2220 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002221 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2222 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2223 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2224 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002225
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002226 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2227 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2228 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2229 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2230 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2231 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2232 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2233 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2234 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002235
2236 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002237 userlist L1
2238 group G1 users tiger,scott
2239 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002240
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002241 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2242 user scott insecure-password elgato
2243 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002244
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002245 userlist L2
2246 group G1
2247 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002248
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002249 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2250 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2251 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002252
2253 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002254
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002255
22563.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002257----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002258It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2259several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2260instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2261values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2262automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2263In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2264using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2265tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2266reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2267Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2268that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2269each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002270
2271peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002272 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002273 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2274
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002275bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2276 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2277 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2278
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002279disabled
2280 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2281 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2282 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2283
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002284default-bind [param*]
2285 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2286
2287default-server [param*]
2288 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2289
2290 Arguments:
2291 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2292 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2293 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2294 details.
2295
2296
2297 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2298
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002299enable
2300 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2301
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002302log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2303 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2304 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2305 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2306 more details.
2307
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002308peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002309 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2310 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2311 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2312 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2313 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2314 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2315
2316 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2317 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2318
2319 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2320 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2321 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2322 across all peers.
2323
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002324 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2325 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002326
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002327 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2328 "server" keyword explanation below).
2329
2330server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002331 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002332 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2333 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2334 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2335 of this "peers" section).
2336 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2337
2338
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002339 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002340 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002341 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002342 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2343 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2344 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002345
2346 backend mybackend
2347 mode tcp
2348 balance roundrobin
2349 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2350 stick on src
2351
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002352 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2353 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002354
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002355 Example:
2356 peers mypeers
2357 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2358 default-server ssl verify none
2359 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2360 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002361
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002362
2363table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2364 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2365
2366 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2367 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002368 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002369 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2370 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2371 "stick-table" keyword).
2372
2373 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2374 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2375 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2376 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2377 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2378 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2379 of the stick-table name as follows:
2380
2381 peers mypeers
2382 peer A ...
2383 peer B ...
2384 table t1 ...
2385
2386 frontend fe1
2387 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2388
2389 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2390 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2391
2392 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2393 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2394 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2395 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2396 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2397 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2398 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2399
2400 peers mypeers
2401 peer A ...
2402 peer B ...
2403 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2404
2405 backend t1
2406 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2407
2408 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2409 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2410 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2411
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024123.6. Mailers
2413------------
2414It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2415If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2416in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2417
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002418mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002419 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2420 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2421
2422mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2423 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2424
2425 Example:
2426 mailers mymailers
2427 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2428 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2429
2430 backend mybackend
2431 mode tcp
2432 balance roundrobin
2433
2434 email-alert mailers mymailers
2435 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2436 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2437
2438 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2439 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2440
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002441timeout mail <time>
2442 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2443 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2444 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2445 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2446
2447 Example:
2448 mailers mymailers
2449 timeout mail 20s
2450 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002451
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024523.7. Programs
2453-------------
2454In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2455master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2456managed the same way as the workers.
2457
2458During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2459sequence as a worker:
2460
2461 - the master is re-executed
2462 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2463 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2464 instance of the program
2465
2466During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2467
2468program <name>
2469 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2470 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2471 the management guide).
2472
2473command <command> [arguments*]
2474 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2475 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2476 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2477 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2478
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002479user <user name>
2480 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2481 See also "group".
2482
2483group <group name>
2484 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2485 See also "user".
2486
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002487option start-on-reload
2488no option start-on-reload
2489 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2490 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2491 program section.
2492
2493
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024943.8. HTTP-errors
2495----------------
2496
2497It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2498imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2499several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2500
2501http-errors <name>
2502 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2503 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2504
2505errorfile <code> <file>
2506 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2507
2508 Arguments :
2509 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2510 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2511 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2512
2513 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2514 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2515 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2516 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2517 before any chroot is performed.
2518
2519 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2520
2521 Example:
2522 http-errors website-1
2523 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2524 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2525 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2526
2527 http-errors website-2
2528 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2529 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2530 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2531
2532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025334. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002534----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002536Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002537 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002538 - frontend <name>
2539 - backend <name>
2540 - listen <name>
2541
2542A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2543its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2544section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002545section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002546
2547A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2548connections.
2549
2550A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2551to forward incoming connections.
2552
2553A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2554parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002556All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2557'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2558case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2559
2560Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2561logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2562proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2563However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2564name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2565
2566Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2567and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002568bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2570modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2571arbitrary criteria.
2572
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002573In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2574a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002575the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002576
2577 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2578 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2579 between responses and new requests.
2580
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002581 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2582 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2583 client-facing connection remains open.
2584
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002585 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2586 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002587
2588The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2589frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2590following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002591weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002592
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002593 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002594
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002595 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2596 ----+-----+-----+----
2597 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2598 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002599 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2600 ----+-----+-----+----
2601 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002602
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026054.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2606--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002608The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2609limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2610they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2611limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002612marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002613option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002614and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2615with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2616specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002617
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002618
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002619 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2620------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2621acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002622backlog X X X -
2623balance X - X X
2624bind - X X -
2625bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002626capture cookie - X X -
2627capture request header - X X -
2628capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002629compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002630cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002631declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002632default-server X - X X
2633default_backend X X X -
2634description - X X X
2635disabled X X X X
2636dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002637email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002638email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002639email-alert mailers X X X X
2640email-alert myhostname X X X X
2641email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002642enabled X X X X
2643errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002644errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002645errorloc X X X X
2646errorloc302 X X X X
2647-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2648errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002649force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002650filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002651fullconn X - X X
2652grace X X X X
2653hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002654http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002655http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002656http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002657http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002658http-check expect X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002659http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002660http-check set-var X - X X
2661http-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002662http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002663http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002664http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002665http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002666id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002667ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002668load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002669log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002670log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002671log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002672log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002673max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002674maxconn X X X -
2675mode X X X X
2676monitor fail - X X -
2677monitor-net X X X -
2678monitor-uri X X X -
2679option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2680option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2681option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2682option allbackups (*) X - X X
2683option checkcache (*) X - X X
2684option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2685option contstats (*) X X X -
2686option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2687option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002688-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2689option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002690option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2691option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002692option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002693option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002694option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002695option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002696option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002697option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2698option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2699option httpchk X - X X
2700option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002701option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002702option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002703option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002704option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002705option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002706option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2707option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2708option logasap (*) X X X -
2709option mysql-check X - X X
2710option nolinger (*) X X X X
2711option originalto X X X X
2712option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002713option pgsql-check X - X X
2714option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002715option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002716option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002717option smtpchk X - X X
2718option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2719option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2720option splice-request (*) X X X X
2721option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002722option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002723option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2724option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2725-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002726option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002727option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2728option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2729option tcpka X X X X
2730option tcplog X X X X
2731option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002732external-check command X - X X
2733external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002734persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2735rate-limit sessions X X X -
2736redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002737-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002738retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002739retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002740server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002741server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002742server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002743source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002744stats admin - X X X
2745stats auth X X X X
2746stats enable X X X X
2747stats hide-version X X X X
2748stats http-request - X X X
2749stats realm X X X X
2750stats refresh X X X X
2751stats scope X X X X
2752stats show-desc X X X X
2753stats show-legends X X X X
2754stats show-node X X X X
2755stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002756-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2757stick match - - X X
2758stick on - - X X
2759stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002760stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002761stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002762tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002763tcp-check connect X - X X
2764tcp-check expect X - X X
2765tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002766tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002767tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002768tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002769tcp-check set-var X - X X
2770tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002771tcp-request connection - X X -
2772tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002773tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002774tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002775tcp-response content - - X X
2776tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002777timeout check X - X X
2778timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002779timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002780timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002781timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2782timeout http-request X X X X
2783timeout queue X - X X
2784timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002785timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002786timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002787timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002788transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002789unique-id-format X X X -
2790unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002791use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002792use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002793use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002794------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2795 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027984.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2799---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002800
2801This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2802
2803
2804acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2805 Declare or complete an access list.
2806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2807 no | yes | yes | yes
2808 Example:
2809 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2810 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2811 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002813 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002814
2815
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002816backlog <conns>
2817 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2819 yes | yes | yes | no
2820 Arguments :
2821 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2822 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002823 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002824
2825 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2826 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2827 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2828 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2829 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2830 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2831 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2832 backlog parameter.
2833
2834 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2835 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2836 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2837
2838 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2839
2840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002842balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002843 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2845 yes | no | yes | yes
2846 Arguments :
2847 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2848 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2849 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2850 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2851
2852 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2853 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2854 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2855 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002856 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002857 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002858 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2859 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2860 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2861 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2862 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2863 it, so that you don't worry.
2864
2865 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2866 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2867 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2868 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2869 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2870 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2871 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2872 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002873
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002874 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2875 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2876 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2877 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2878 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2879 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2880 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2881 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2882
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002883 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002884 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002885 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2886 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002887 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002888 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2889 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2890 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2891 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2892 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002893 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2894 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2895 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2896 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2897 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2898 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002899
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002900 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2901 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2902 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2903 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2904 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2905 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2906 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2907 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002908 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002909 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002910 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2911 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2912 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002913
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002914 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2915 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2916 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2917 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2918 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2919 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2920 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2921 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2922 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2923 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2924 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2925 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002926
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002927 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002928 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2929 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2930 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2931 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2932 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2933 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2934 URIs start with a leading "/".
2935
2936 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2937 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2938 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2939 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2940
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002941 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002942 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2943
2944 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002945 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2946 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002947 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2948 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2949 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2950 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002951 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002952 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2953 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002954
2955 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2956 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2957 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2958 server will receive the request.
2959
2960 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2961 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2962 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2963 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2964 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002965 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2966 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2967 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002968
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002969 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2970 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2971 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2972 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2973 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002975 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002976 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2977 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2978 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2979
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002980 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2981 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2982 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2983
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002984 random
2985 random(<draws>)
2986 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002987 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2988 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2989 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2990 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002991 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2992 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2993 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2994 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2995 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2996 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2997 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2998 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2999 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3000 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3001 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3002 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3003 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3004 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3005 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3006 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3007 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3008 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3009 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3010 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003011
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003012 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003013 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003014 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3015 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3016 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3017 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3018 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3019 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003020 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003021 used instead.
3022
3023 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3024 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3025 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3026 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3027
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003028 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3029 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3030 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3031
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003032 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003034 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003035 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3036 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003037
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003038 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3039 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3040 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003041
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003042 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003043 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003044 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3045 NTLM relies on.
3046
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003047 Examples :
3048 balance roundrobin
3049 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003050 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003051 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3052 balance hdr(host)
3053 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003054
3055 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3056 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3057
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003058 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003059 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3060 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3061 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003062 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003063
3064 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3065 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3066 defaults to 16 kB.
3067
3068 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3069 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3070
3071 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3072 Round Robin.
3073
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003074 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003075 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3076 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3077 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3078
3079 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3080
3081 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003082 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003083 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3084 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3085 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003086
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003087 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003088
3089
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003090bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3091bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003092 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3094 no | yes | yes | no
3095 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003096 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3097 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3098 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3099 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003100 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003101 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3102 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3103 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3104 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3105 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3106 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3107 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003108 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3109 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3110 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3111 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3112 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3113 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3114 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003115 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3116 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3117 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003118 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3119 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3120 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3121 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003122 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3123 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3124 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003125
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003126 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3127 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003128 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3129 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3130 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003131 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3132 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3133 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3134 the range.
3135
3136 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3137 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3138 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3139 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3140 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3141 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3142 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003143 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003144 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003145
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003146 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003147 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003148 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3149 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3150 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3151 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3152 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3153 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3154
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003155 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3156 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3157 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3158 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003159
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003160 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3161 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3162 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3163 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3164 in a frontend.
3165
3166 Example :
3167 listen http_proxy
3168 bind :80,:443
3169 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003170 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003171
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003172 listen http_https_proxy
3173 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003174 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003175
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003176 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3177 bind ipv6@:80
3178 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3179 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3180
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003181 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003182 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003183
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003184 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3185 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3186 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3187 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3188 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3189
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003190 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003191 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003192
3193
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003194bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003195 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3197 yes | yes | yes | yes
3198 Arguments :
3199 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3200 may be used to override a default value.
3201
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003202 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003203 option may be combined with other numbers.
3204
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003205 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003206 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3207 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3208 missing from all processes.
3209
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003210 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003211 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003212 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3213 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3214 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3215 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3216 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003217 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003218
3219 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3220 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3221 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3222 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3223 and 'even' instances.
3224
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003225 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3226 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3227 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3228 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003229
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003230 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3231 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3232
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003233 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3234 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3235 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3236
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003237 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3238 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3239
3240 Example :
3241 listen app_ip1
3242 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003243 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003244
3245 listen app_ip2
3246 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003247 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003248
3249 listen management
3250 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003251 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003252
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003253 listen management
3254 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3255 bind-process 1-4
3256
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003257 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003258
3259
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003260capture cookie <name> len <length>
3261 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3263 no | yes | yes | no
3264 Arguments :
3265 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3266 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3267 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3268 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003269 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003270
3271 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3272 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3273 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3274 right if it exceeds <length>.
3275
3276 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3277 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3278 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3279 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3280
3281 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3282 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3283 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3284
3285 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3286 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3287 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003288 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3289 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3290 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003291
3292 Example:
3293 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3294
3295 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003296 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003297
3298
3299capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003300 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3302 no | yes | yes | no
3303 Arguments :
3304 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003305 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3307 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3308 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3309
3310 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3311 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3312 it exceeds <length>.
3313
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003314 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003315 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3316 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003317 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3318 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3319 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3320 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003321 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003322 environments to find where the request came from.
3323
3324 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3325 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3326 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3327 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003328
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003329 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3330 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3331 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3332 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3333 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003334
3335 Example:
3336 capture request header Host len 15
3337 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003338 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003340 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003341 about logging.
3342
3343
3344capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003345 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3347 no | yes | yes | no
3348 Arguments :
3349 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003350 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003351 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3352 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3353 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3354
3355 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3356 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3357 it exceeds <length>.
3358
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003359 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003360 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3361 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3362 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003363 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3364 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3365 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3366 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003367
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003368 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3369 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3370 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3371 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3372 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003373
3374 Example:
3375 capture response header Content-length len 9
3376 capture response header Location len 15
3377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003378 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003379 about logging.
3380
3381
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003382compression algo <algorithm> ...
3383compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003384compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003385 Enable HTTP compression.
3386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3387 yes | yes | yes | yes
3388 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003389 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3390 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3391 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3392
3393 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003394 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3395 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3396 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003397
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003398 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003399 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003400
3401 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3402 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3403 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3404 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3405 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003406 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003407
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003408 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3409 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3410 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3411 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3412 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3413 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3414 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003415 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003416
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003417 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003418 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003419 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3420 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3421 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3422 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3423 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003424
3425 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3426 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3427 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3428 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3429 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003430 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3431 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3432 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3433 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3434 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003435 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3436 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003437
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003438 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003439 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3440 "Accept-Encoding" header
3441 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003442 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003443 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3444 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3445 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3446 "multipart"
3447 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3448 header
3449 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3450 and later
3451 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3452 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003453 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003454
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003455 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003456
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003457 Examples :
3458 compression algo gzip
3459 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003460
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003461
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003462cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003463 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3464 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003465 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003466 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3468 yes | no | yes | yes
3469 Arguments :
3470 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3471 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3472 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3473 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3474 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3475 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003476 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003477 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3478 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3479
3480 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3481 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3482 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3483 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3484 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3485 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003486 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3487 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003488 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003489 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3490 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003491
3492 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003493 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003494
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003495 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003496 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003497 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003498 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003499 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3500 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3501 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3502 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3503 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3504 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3505 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003506
3507 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3508 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3509 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3510 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3511 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3512 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3513 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3514 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3515 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003516 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003517 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3518 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3519 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003520
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003521 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3522 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3523 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003524 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3525 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3526 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3527 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003528 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3529 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3530 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003531
3532 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3533 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3534 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3535 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3536 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3537 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3538 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3539 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3540 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3541
3542 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3543 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3544 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3545 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3546 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3547 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3548 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3549 persistence cookie in the cache.
3550 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3551
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003552 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3553 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3554 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3555 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3556 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003557 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003558 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3559 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3560 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3561 they logout.
3562
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003563 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3564 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3565 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3566 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3567
3568 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3569 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3570 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3571 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3572 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3573 this attribute.
3574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003575 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003576 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003577 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3578 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3579 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3580 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3581 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3582 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003583
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003584 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3585 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3586 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3587 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3588 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3589 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3590 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3591 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003592 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003593 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3594 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3595 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3596 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3597 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3598 the site.
3599
3600 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3601 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3602 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3603 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3604 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3605 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3606 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3607 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3608 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3609 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3610 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3611 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3612 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003613 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003614 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3615 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3616
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003617 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3618 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3619 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3620 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3621 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3622 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3623
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003624 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3625 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3626 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3627 repeated.
3628
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003629 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3630 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3631 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3632 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003634 Examples :
3635 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3636 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3637 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003638 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003639
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003640 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003641
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003642
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003643declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3644 Declares a capture slot.
3645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3646 no | yes | yes | no
3647 Arguments:
3648 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3649
3650 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3651 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3652 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3653 for use in the response.
3654
3655 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003656 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003657 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3658
3659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003660default-server [param*]
3661 Change default options for a server in a backend
3662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3663 yes | no | yes | yes
3664 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003665 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3666 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3667 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3668 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003669
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003670 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003671 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3672
3673 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003674
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003675
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003676default_backend <backend>
3677 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3679 yes | yes | yes | no
3680 Arguments :
3681 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3682
3683 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3684 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3685 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3686 will catch all undetermined requests.
3687
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003688 Example :
3689
3690 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3691 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3692 default_backend dynamic
3693
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003694 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003696
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003697description <string>
3698 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3700 no | yes | yes | yes
3701 Arguments : string
3702
3703 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3704 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3705 it describes.
3706 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3707
3708
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003709disabled
3710 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3712 yes | yes | yes | yes
3713 Arguments : none
3714
3715 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3716 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3717 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3718 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3719 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3720 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3721 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3722
3723 See also : "enabled"
3724
3725
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003726dispatch <address>:<port>
3727 Set a default server address
3728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3729 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003730 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003731
3732 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3733 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3734 during start-up.
3735
3736 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3737 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3738 possible with normal servers.
3739
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003740 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003741 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3742 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3743 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3744 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3745
3746 See also : "server"
3747
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003748
3749dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3750 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3752 yes | no | yes | yes
3753 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3754
3755 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003756 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003757 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3758 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003759 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003760 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003762enabled
3763 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3765 yes | yes | yes | yes
3766 Arguments : none
3767
3768 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3769 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3770
3771 See also : "disabled"
3772
3773
3774errorfile <code> <file>
3775 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3777 yes | yes | yes | yes
3778 Arguments :
3779 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003780 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3781 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003782
3783 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003784 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003785 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003786 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3787 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003788
3789 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3790 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3791 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3792
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003793 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3794
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003795 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3796 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3797 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3798 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3799
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003800 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3801 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003802 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003803 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3804 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3805 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003807 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3808 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3809 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003810 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003811 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3812
3813 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3814
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003815 Example :
3816 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003817 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003818 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3819 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3820
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003821
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003822errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3823 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3824 section.
3825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3826 yes | yes | yes | yes
3827 Arguments :
3828 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3829
3830 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3831 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3832 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3833
3834 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3835 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3836 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3837 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3838 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3839 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3840 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3841
3842 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3843 3.8 about http-errors.
3844
3845 Example :
3846 errorfiles generic
3847 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3848
3849
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003850errorloc <code> <url>
3851errorloc302 <code> <url>
3852 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3854 yes | yes | yes | yes
3855 Arguments :
3856 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003857 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3858 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003859
3860 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3861 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3862 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3863 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003864 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003865
3866 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3867 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3868 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3869
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003870 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3871
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003872 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3873 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3874 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3875 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003876 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003877 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3878 request.
3879
3880 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3881
3882
3883errorloc303 <code> <url>
3884 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3886 yes | yes | yes | yes
3887 Arguments :
3888 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003889 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3890 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003891
3892 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3893 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3894 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3895 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003896 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003897
3898 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3899 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3900 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3901
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003902 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3903
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003904 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3905 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3906 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3907 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003908 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003909
3910 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3911
3912
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003913email-alert from <emailaddr>
3914 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003915 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003916 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3917 yes | yes | yes | yes
3918
3919 Arguments :
3920
3921 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3922
3923 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3924 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3925
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003926 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003927 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3928 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003929
3930
3931email-alert level <level>
3932 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3933 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3934 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3935 yes | yes | yes | yes
3936
3937 Arguments :
3938
3939 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3940 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3941 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3942
3943 By default level is alert
3944
3945 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3946 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3947 for the proxy.
3948
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003949 Alerts are sent when :
3950
3951 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3952 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3953 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3954 is notice or lower
3955 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3956 and a health check status update occurs
3957
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003958 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3959 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003960 section 3.6 about mailers.
3961
3962
3963email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3964 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3966 yes | yes | yes | yes
3967
3968 Arguments :
3969
3970 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3971
3972 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3973 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3974
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003975 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3976 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003977
3978
3979email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3980 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3981 mailers.
3982 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3983 yes | yes | yes | yes
3984
3985 Arguments :
3986
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003987 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003988
3989 By default the systems hostname is used.
3990
3991 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3992 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3993 for the proxy.
3994
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003995 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3996 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003997
3998
3999email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004000 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004001 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4002 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4003 yes | yes | yes | yes
4004
4005 Arguments :
4006
4007 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4008
4009 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4010 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4011
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004012 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004013 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4014
4015
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004016force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4017 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4018 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004019 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004020
4021 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4022 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4023 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4024 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4025 marked down for maintenance operations.
4026
4027 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4028 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4029 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4030 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4031 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4032 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4033 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4034 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4035 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4036
4037 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4038 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4039 is used.
4040
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004041 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004042 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004043
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004044
4045filter <name> [param*]
4046 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4048 no | yes | yes | yes
4049 Arguments :
4050 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4051 referenced in section 9.
4052
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004053 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004054 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004055 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4056 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004057
4058 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4059 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4060
4061 Example:
4062 listen
4063 bind *:80
4064
4065 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4066 filter compression
4067 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4068
4069 compression algo gzip
4070 compression offload
4071
4072 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4073
4074 See also : section 9.
4075
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004076
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004077fullconn <conns>
4078 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4080 yes | no | yes | yes
4081 Arguments :
4082 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4083 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4084
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004085 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004086 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004087 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004088 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4089 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4090 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4091 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4092 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004093 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004094
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004095 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4096 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004097 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4098 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4099 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004100
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004101 Example :
4102 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4103 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4104 # connections.
4105 backend dynamic
4106 fullconn 10000
4107 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4108 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4109
4110 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4111
4112
4113grace <time>
4114 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004116 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004117 Arguments :
4118 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4119 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4120 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4121
4122 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4123 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004124 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004125 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4126
4127 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4128 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4129 simplify it.
4130
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004131
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004132hash-balance-factor <factor>
4133 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4135 yes | no | no | yes
4136 Arguments :
4137 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4138 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004139 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004140
4141 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4142 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4143 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4144 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4145 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4146 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4147 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4148
4149 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4150 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4151 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4152 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4153 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4154
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004155 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4156 consistent hashing mechanism.
4157
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004158 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4159
4160
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004161hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004162 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4164 yes | no | yes | yes
4165 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004166 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4167 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004168
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004169 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4170 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4171 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4172 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4173 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4174 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4175 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4176 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4177 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4178 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004179
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004180 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4181 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4182 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4183 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4184 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4185 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4186 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4187 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4188 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4189 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4190 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4191 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4192 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004193 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4194 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004195
4196 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4197
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004198 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004199 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4200 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4201 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004202 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4203 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4204 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004205
4206 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4207 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004208 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4209 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4210 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4211 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4212
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004213 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4214 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4215 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4216 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4217 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4218 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4219 parameter.
4220
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004221 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4222 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4223 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4224 used on strings.
4225
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004226 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4227
4228 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4229 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4230 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4231 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4232 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4233 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4234 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4235 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4236 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4237 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4238 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4239 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004240
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004241 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4242 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4243 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004244
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004245 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004246
4247
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004248http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4249 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4250 ones).
4251
4252 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4253 no | yes | yes | yes
4254
4255 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4256 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4257 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4258 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4259 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4260 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4261
4262 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4263 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4264 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4265
4266 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4267 below.
4268
4269 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4270 instance.
4271
4272 Example:
4273 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4274 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4275 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4276
4277http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4278
4279 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4280 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4281 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4282 example, or to pass some internal information.
4283 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4284 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4285 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4286
4287http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4288
4289 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4290 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4291
4292http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4293
4294 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4295
4296http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4297 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4298
4299 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4300
4301 Example:
4302 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4303
4304 # applied to:
4305 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4306
4307 # outputs:
4308 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4309
4310 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4311
4312http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4313 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4314
4315 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4316
4317 Example:
4318 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4319
4320 # applied to:
4321 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4322
4323 # outputs:
4324 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4325
4326http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4327
4328 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4329 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4330 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4331
4332http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4333 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4334
4335 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4336 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4337 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4338 fallback.
4339
4340 Example:
4341 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4342 http-response set-status 431
4343 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4344 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4345
4346http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4347
4348 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4349 inline.
4350
4351 Arguments:
4352 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4353 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4354 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4355 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4356 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4357 (request and response)
4358 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4359 processing
4360 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4361 processing
4362 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4363 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4364 and '_'.
4365
4366 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4367 followed by some converters.
4368
4369 Example:
4370 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4371
4372http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4373
4374 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4375 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4376 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4377 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4378 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004379 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004380 processing.
4381
4382 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4383 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4384 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4385 rules evaluation.
4386
4387http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4388
4389 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4390 details about <var-name>.
4391
4392 Example:
4393 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4394
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004395
4396http-check comment <string>
4397 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4398 it fails.
4399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4400 yes | no | yes | yes
4401
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004402 Arguments :
4403 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4404 rule fails.
4405
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004406 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4407 user-friendly error reporting.
4408
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004409 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check conncet", "http-check send" and
4410 "http-check expect".
4411
4412
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004413http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4414 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004415 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004416 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4418 yes | no | yes | yes
4419
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004420 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004421 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4422
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004423 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
4424 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
4425
4426 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4427 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4428 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4429 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4430
4431 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4432
4433 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4434
4435 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4436
4437 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4438
4439 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4440
4441 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4442 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4443 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4444 is used.
4445
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004446 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4447 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4448 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4449 haproxy -vv.
4450
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004451 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4452
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004453 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4454 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4455 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4456 different ports or with different servers.
4457
4458 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4459 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4460 the port with a "http-check connect".
4461
4462 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4463 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4464 do.
4465
4466 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4467 unset-var or comment rules.
4468
4469 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004470 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4471 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4472 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4473 option httpchk
4474
4475 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004476 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004477 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004478 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004479 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004480 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004481
4482 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4483
4484 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004485
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004486
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004487http-check disable-on-404
4488 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004490 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004491 Arguments : none
4492
4493 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4494 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4495 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4496 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4497 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4498 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4499 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4500 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004501 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4502 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4503 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4504
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004505 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004506
4507
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004508http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004509 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4510 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4511 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004512 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004514 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004515
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004516 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004517 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4518
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004519 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4520 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4521 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4522 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4523 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4524 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4525 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4526 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4527 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4528 result is always conclusive.
4529
4530 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4531 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4532 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004533 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4534 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4535 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4536 example 404 with disable-on-404
4537 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4538 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4539 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004540
4541 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4542 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004543 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4544 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4545 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4546 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4547 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4548 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004549
4550 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4551 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004552 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4553 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4554 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4555 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004556 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4557
4558 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4559 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4560 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4561 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4562
4563 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4564 informational message reported in logs if an error
4565 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4566 log-format string.
4567
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004568 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004569 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4570 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004571 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4572 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4573 details on the supported keywords.
4574
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004575 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4576 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4577 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4578 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004579
4580 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4581 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4582 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4583 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4584 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4585
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004586 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4587 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4588 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4589 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4590 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4591 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4592 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004593
4594 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004595 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004596 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4597 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4598 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4599 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4600
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004601 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4602 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004603 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4604 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4605 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4606 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4607 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4608 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4609 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4610 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004611 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4612 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4613 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4614 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4615 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4616 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4617 insensitive on the header names.
4618
4619 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4620 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4621 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4622 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4623 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4624 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004625
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004626 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004627 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004628 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4629 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4630 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4631 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4632 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004633 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004634 trace).
4635
4636 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004637 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004638 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4639 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4640 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4641 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4642 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004643 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004644
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004645 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4646 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4647 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4648 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4649 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4650 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4651
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004652 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4653 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4654 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4655 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4656 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4657 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4658 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4659 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4660
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004661 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4662 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4663 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4664 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4665 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004666
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004667 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4668 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4669
4670 Examples :
4671 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004672 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004673
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004674 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
4675 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
4676
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004677 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004678 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004679
4680 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004681 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004682
4683 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004684 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004685
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004686 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004687 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004688
4689
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004690http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004691 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
4692 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004693 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4694 health checks.
4695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4696 yes | no | yes | yes
4697 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004698 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4699
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004700 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4701 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4702 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4703 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4704 to invent non-standard ones.
4705
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004706 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4707 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
4708 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
4709 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4710
4711 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4712 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
4713 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4714 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004715
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004716 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004717 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
4718 1.0, so turningit to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
4719 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4720 to add it.
4721
4722 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4723 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4724 to the log-format rules.
4725
4726 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4727 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4728 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004729
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004730 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
4731 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4732 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
4733 request.
4734
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004735 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4736 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4737 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004738 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
4739 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
4740 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
4741 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004742 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4743 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4744 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4745
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004746 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4747 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004748 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
4749 so, it will be ignored.
4750
4751 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
4752 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
4753 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
4754 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
4755 configured request authority.
4756
4757 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
4758 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004759
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004760 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004761
4762
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004763http-check send-state
4764 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4766 yes | no | yes | yes
4767 Arguments : none
4768
4769 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4770 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4771 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4772 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4773 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4774
4775 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4776 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4777 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4778 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4779 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004780 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4781 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4782 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4783
4784 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4785 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4786 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4787
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004788 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4789 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4790 checked in multiple backends.
4791
4792 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4793 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4794
4795 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4796 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4797 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4798 one fails.
4799
4800 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4801 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4802 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4803
4804 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4805 server's queue.
4806
4807 Example of a header received by the application server :
4808 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4809 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4810
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004811 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
4812 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004813
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004814
4815http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004816 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004817 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4818 yes | no | yes | yes
4819
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004820 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004821 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4822 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4823 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4824 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4825 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4826 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4827 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4828 and '-'.
4829
4830 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
4831
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004832 Examples :
4833 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004834
4835
4836http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004837 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4839 yes | no | yes | yes
4840
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004841 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004842 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4843 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4844 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4845 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4846 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4847 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4848 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4849 and '-'.
4850
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004851 Examples :
4852 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004853
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004854
4855http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004856 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4857
4858 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4859 no | yes | yes | yes
4860
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004861 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4862 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4863 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4864 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4865 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004866
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004867 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4868 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004869
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004870 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004871
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004872 Example:
4873 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4874 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4875 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004876
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004877 http-request allow if nagios
4878 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4879 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4880 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004881
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004882 Example:
4883 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4884 acl add path /addacl
4885 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004887 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004888
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004889 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4890 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004891
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004892 Example:
4893 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4894 acl setmap path /setmap
4895 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004896
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004897 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004898
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004899 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4900 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004901
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004902 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4903 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004904
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004905http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004906
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004907 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4908 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4909 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4910 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4911 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4912 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4913 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4914 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004915
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004916http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004917
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004918 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4919 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4920 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4921 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4922 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4923 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4924 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4925 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004926
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004927http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004928
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004929 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4930 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004931
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004932
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004933http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004934
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004935 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4936 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4937 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4938 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4939 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004940
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004941 Example:
4942 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4943 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004944
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004945http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004946
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004947 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004948
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004949http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4950 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004951
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004952 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4953 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4954 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4955 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4956 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4957 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4958 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4959 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4960 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004961
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004962 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4963 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4964 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004965 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4966
4967 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4968 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4969 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4970 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004971
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004972http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004973
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004974 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4975 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4976 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4977 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4978 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4979 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004980
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004981http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004983 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004984
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004985http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004986
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004987 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4988 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4989 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4990 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4991 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4992 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004993
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004994http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4995 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004996
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004997 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4998 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4999 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005000 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5001 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5002 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5003 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5004 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005005 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005006
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005007http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5008 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5009 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5010 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5011
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005012http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5013
5014 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5015 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5016 pointed by <resolvers>.
5017 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5018 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5019 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5020 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5021 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5022 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5023 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5024 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5025 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5026 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5027 to 0.0.0.0.
5028
5029 Example:
5030 resolvers mydns
5031 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5032 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5033 timeout retry 1s
5034 hold valid 10s
5035 hold nx 3s
5036 hold other 3s
5037 hold obsolete 0s
5038 accepted_payload_size 8192
5039
5040 frontend fe
5041 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5042 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5043 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5044
5045 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5046 # which mean DNS resolution error
5047 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5048
5049 default_backend be
5050
5051 backend b_503
5052 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5053 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5054 # 503 error page to end users
5055
5056 backend be
5057 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5058 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5059 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5060 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5061 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5062
5063 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5064 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5065
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005066http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5067
5068 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5069 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5070 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5071 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005072 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5073 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005074
5075 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5076
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005077http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005078
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005079 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5080 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5081 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5082 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5083 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005084
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005085http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005087 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5088 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5089 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5090 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005092http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5093 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005094
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005095 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005096 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5097 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5098 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5099 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5100 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005101
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005102 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5103 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5104 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5105 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5106 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005107
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005108 Example:
5109 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5110
5111 # applied to:
5112 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5113
5114 # outputs:
5115 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5116
5117 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005118
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005119 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5120
5121 # applied to:
5122 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005123
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005124 # outputs:
5125 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005126
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005127http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5128 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5129
5130 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5131 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5132 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5133 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5134
5135 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5136 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5137 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5138
5139 Example:
5140 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5141 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5142
5143 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5144 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5145
5146 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5147 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5148 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5149 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5150
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005151http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5152 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5153
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005154 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5155 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5156 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5157 against.
5158
5159 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5160 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5161 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005162
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005163 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5164 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5165 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5166 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5167 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5168 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5169 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5170 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5171 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005172 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5173 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005174
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005175 Example:
5176 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5177 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005178
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005179 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5180 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005182http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5183 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005184
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005185 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5186 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5187 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5188 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005189
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005190 Example:
5191 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005192
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005193 # applied to:
5194 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005195
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005196 # outputs:
5197 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005198
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005199http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5200 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5201 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005202 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005203 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5204
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005205 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005206 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5207 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5208 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5209 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005210 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005211 are followed to create the response :
5212
5213 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5214 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5215 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5216 ignored.
5217
5218 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5219 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5220 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5221 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5222 ignored.
5223
5224 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5225 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5226 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5227 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5228 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5229
5230 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5231 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5232 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5233 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5234 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5235 if any, is ignored.
5236
5237 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5238 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5239 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5240 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5241 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5242 as a raw content.
5243
5244 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5245 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5246 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5247 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5248 considered as a raw string.
5249
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005250 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5251 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5252 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5253 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5254
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005255 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5256 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5257 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5258
5259 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5260
5261 Example:
5262 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5263 if { path /ping }
5264
5265 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5266 if { path /favicon.ico }
5267
5268 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5269 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5270 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005272http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5273http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005275 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5276 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5277 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005278
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005279http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5280 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005281
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005282 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5283 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5284 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5285 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005287http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005289 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5290 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5291 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5292 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5293 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005295 Arguments:
5296 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5297 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005299 Example:
5300 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5301 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005302
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005303 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5304 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005306http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005308 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5309 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5310 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005312 Arguments:
5313 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5314 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005316 Example:
5317 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5318 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005320 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5321 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5322 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005324http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005326 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5327 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5328 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5329 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5330 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005331
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005332 Example:
5333 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5334 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5335 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5336 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5337 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5338 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5339 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5340 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5341 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005342
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005343http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005344
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005345 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5346 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5347 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5348 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5349 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005351http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5352 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005354 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5355 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5356 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5357 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5358 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5359 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5360 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5361 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5362 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005364http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005365
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005366 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5367 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5368 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5369 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5370 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5371 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5372 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005374http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005376 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5377 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5378 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005380http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005382 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5383 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5384 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5385 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5386 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5387 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5388 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5389 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005390
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005391http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005392
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005393 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5394 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5395 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5396 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5397 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5398 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005400 Example :
5401 # prepend the host name before the path
5402 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005404http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005406 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5407 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5408 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5409 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5410 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005411
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005412http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005413
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005414 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5415 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5416 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5417 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5418 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5419 values have higher priority.
5420 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5421 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5422 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5423 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5424 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005426http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005428 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5429 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5430 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5431 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5432 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5433 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5434 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005436 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005437
5438 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005439 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5440 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005442http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5443 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5444 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5445 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005446 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5447 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005448
5449 Arguments :
5450 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5451 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005452
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005453 See also "option forwardfor".
5454
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005455 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005456 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5457 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5458
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005459 # After the masking this will track connections
5460 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5461 http-request track-sc0 src
5462
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005463 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5464 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5465
5466http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5467
5468 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5469 expression.
5470
5471 Arguments:
5472 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5473 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005474
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005475 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005476 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5477 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5478
5479 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5480 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5481 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5482
5483http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5484
5485 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5486 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5487 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5488 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5489 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5490 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5491 information from the request.
5492
5493 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5494
5495http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5496
5497 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5498 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5499 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5500 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5501 path and the query string.
5502 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5503
5504http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5505
5506 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5507 inline.
5508
5509 Arguments:
5510 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5511 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5512 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5513 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5514 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5515 (request and response)
5516 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5517 processing
5518 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5519 processing
5520 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5521 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5522 and '_'.
5523
5524 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5525 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005526
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005527 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005528 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005530http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5531 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005533 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5534 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5535 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5536 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5537 agent name must be used.
5538
5539 Arguments:
5540 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5541
5542 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5543 configuration.
5544
5545http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5546
5547 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5548 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5549 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5550 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5551 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5552 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5553 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5554 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5555 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5556 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5557 action.
5558 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5559 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5560 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5561 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5562 you fully understand how it works.
5563
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005564http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5565
5566 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5567 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5568 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5569 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5570 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005571 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005572 processing.
5573
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005574 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005575 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5576 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5577 rules evaluation.
5578
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005579http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5580 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005581
5582 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5583 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5584 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5585 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5586 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5587 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5588 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5589 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5590 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5591 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5592 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005593 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5594 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5595 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5596 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5597 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005598 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5599
5600http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5601http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5602http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5603
5604 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5605 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5606 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5607 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5608 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5609 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5610 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5611 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5612 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5613 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5614 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5615 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5616
5617 Arguments :
5618 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5619 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5620 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5621 select which table entry to update the counters.
5622
5623 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5624 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5625 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5626 that table until the session ends.
5627
5628 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5629 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5630 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5631 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5632 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5633 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5634 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5635 useful information.
5636
5637 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5638 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5639 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5640 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5641 checks that make use of it.
5642
5643http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5644
5645 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005646
5647 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005648 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005649
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005650http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5651
5652 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5653 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5654 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5655 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5656 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5657 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5658
5659 Arguments :
5660 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5661
5662 Example:
5663 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005665http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005666
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005667 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5668 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5669 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005670
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005671
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005672http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005673 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5674
5675 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5676 no | yes | yes | yes
5677
5678 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5679 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5680 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5681 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5682 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5683 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5684
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005685 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5686 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005687
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005688 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005689
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005690 Example:
5691 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005692
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005693 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005694
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005695 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5696 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005697
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005698 Example:
5699 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005700
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005701 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005702
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005703 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5704 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005705
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005706 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5707 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005708
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005709http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005710
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005711 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5712 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5713 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5714 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5715 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5716 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5717 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5718 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005719
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005720http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005721
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005722 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5723 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5724 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5725 example, or to pass some internal information.
5726 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5727 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5728 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005729
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005730http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005731
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005732 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5733 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005734
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005735http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005736
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005737 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005738
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005739http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005740
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005741 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5742 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5743 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5744 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5745 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5746 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5747 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005748
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005749 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5750 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5751 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5752 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5753 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005754
5755 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5756 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5757 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5758 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005759
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005760http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005761
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005762 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5763 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5764 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5765 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5766 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5767 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005768
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005769http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005770
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005771 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005772
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005773http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005774
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005775 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5776 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5777 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5778 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5779 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5780 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005781
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005782http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5783 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005784
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005785 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005786 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5787 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005788 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5789 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5790 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5791 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5792 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005793 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005794
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005795http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005796
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005797 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5798 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5799 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5800 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5801 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5802 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005803
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005804http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5805 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005806
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005807 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5808 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005809
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005810 Example:
5811 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005812
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005813 # applied to:
5814 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005815
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005816 # outputs:
5817 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005818
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005819 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005820
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005821http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5822 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005823
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005824 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005825 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005826
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005827 Example:
5828 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005829
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005830 # applied to:
5831 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005832
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005833 # outputs:
5834 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005835
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005836http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5837 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5838 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005839 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005840 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5841
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005842 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005843 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5844 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5845 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5846 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005847 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005848 are followed to create the response :
5849
5850 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5851 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5852 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5853 ignored.
5854
5855 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5856 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5857 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5858 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5859 ignored.
5860
5861 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5862 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5863 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5864 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5865 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5866
5867 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5868 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5869 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5870 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5871 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5872 if any, is ignored.
5873
5874 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5875 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5876 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5877 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5878 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5879 as a raw content.
5880
5881 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5882 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5883 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5884 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5885 considered as a raw string.
5886
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005887 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5888 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5889 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5890 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5891
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005892 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5893 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5894 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5895
5896 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5897
5898 Example:
5899 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5900 if { status eq 404 }
5901
5902 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5903 string "This is the end !" \
5904 if { status eq 500 }
5905
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005906http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5907http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005908
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005909 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5910 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5911 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005912
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005913http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5914 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005915
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005916 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5917 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5918 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5919 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005920
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005921http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005922
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005923 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5924 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5925 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5926 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5927 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005928
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005929 Arguments:
5930 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005931
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005932 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5933 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005934
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005935http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005937 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5938 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5939 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005940
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005941http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5942
5943 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5944 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5945 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5946 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5947 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5948
5949http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5950
5951 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5952 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5953 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5954 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5955 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5956 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5957 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5958 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5959 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5960
5961http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5962
5963 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5964 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5965 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5966 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5967 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5968 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5969 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5970
5971http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5972
5973 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5974 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5975 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5976 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5977 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5978 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5979 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5980 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5981
5982http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5983 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5984
5985 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5986 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5987 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5988 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005989
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005990 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005991 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5992 http-response set-status 431
5993 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5994 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005995
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005996http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005998 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5999 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6000 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6001 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6002 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6003 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6004 based on some information from the request.
6005
6006 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6007
6008http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6009
6010 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6011 inline.
6012
6013 Arguments:
6014 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6015 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6016 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6017 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6018 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6019 (request and response)
6020 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6021 processing
6022 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6023 processing
6024 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6025 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6026 and '_'.
6027
6028 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6029 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006030
6031 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006032 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006034http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006036 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6037 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6038 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6039 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6040 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6041 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6042 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6043 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6044 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6045 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6046 action.
6047 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6048 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6049 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6050 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6051 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006052
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006053http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6054
6055 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6056 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6057 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6058 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6059 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006060 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006061 processing.
6062
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006063 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006064 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6065 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
6066 rules evaluation.
6067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006068http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6069http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6070http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006072 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6073 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6074 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6075 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6076 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6077 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6078
6079http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6080
6081 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6082 about <var-name>.
6083
6084 Example:
6085 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6086
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006087
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006088http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6089 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6090
6091 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6092 yes | no | yes | yes
6093
6094 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006095 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6096 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6097 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006098
6099 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6100
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006101 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6102 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6103 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6104 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6105 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6106 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6107 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6108 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6109 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6110 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006111
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006112 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6113 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6114 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6115 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6116 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6117 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6118 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6119 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006120
6121 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6122 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6123 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6124 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6125 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6126 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6127 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6128 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006129 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006130 downsides of rare connection failures.
6131
6132 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6133 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6134 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6135 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6136 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6137 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006138 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006139 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6140 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6141 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6142 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6143 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6144
6145 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006146 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6147 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6148 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006149
6150 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006151 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006152
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006153 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6154 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006155
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006156 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006157
6158 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6159 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6160 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6161
6162 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6163
6164
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006165http-send-name-header [<header>]
6166 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006167 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6168 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006169 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006170 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6171
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006172 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6173 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6174 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6175 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6176 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6177 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6178 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6179 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6180 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6181 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6182 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6183 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6184 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6185 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6186 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6187 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006188
6189 See also : "server"
6190
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006191id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006192 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6194 no | yes | yes | yes
6195 Arguments : none
6196
6197 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6198 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6199 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006200
6201
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006202ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6203 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6204 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006205 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006206
6207 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6208 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6209 and running).
6210
6211 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6212 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6213 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006214 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006215 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6216
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006217 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6218 "unless" condition is met.
6219
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006220 Example:
6221 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6222 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6223 ignore-persist if url_static
6224
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006225 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6226
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006227load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6228 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6229 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6230 yes | no | yes | yes
6231
6232 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6233 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6234 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006235 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006236 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6237 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6238 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6239 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6240
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006241 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006242 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006243 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006244
6245 Arguments:
6246 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6247 named "server-state-file".
6248
6249 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6250 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6251 name is used as a file name.
6252
6253 none don't load any stat for this backend
6254
6255 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006256 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6257 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6258 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006259 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006260 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006261
6262 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6263 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6264
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006265 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006266
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006267 global
6268 stats socket /tmp/socket
6269 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006270
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006271 defaults
6272 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006273
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006274 backend bk
6275 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6276 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006277
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006278
6279 Then one can run :
6280
6281 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6282
6283 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6284
6285 1
6286 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6287 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6288 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6289
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006290 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006291
6292 global
6293 stats socket /tmp/socket
6294 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6295
6296 defaults
6297 load-server-state-from-file local
6298
6299 backend bk
6300 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6301 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6302
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006303
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006304 Then one can run :
6305
6306 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6307
6308 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6309
6310 1
6311 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6312 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6313 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6314
6315 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6316 "show servers state"
6317
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006318
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006319log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006320log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6321 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006322no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006323 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6325 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006326
6327 Prefix :
6328 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6329 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6330 prefix does not allow arguments.
6331
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006332 Arguments :
6333 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6334 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6335 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6336 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6337 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6338 parameter.
6339
6340 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6341 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6342
6343 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6344 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6345 standard syslog port).
6346
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006347 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6348 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6349 standard syslog port).
6350
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006351 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6352 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6353 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006354 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006355
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006356 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6357 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6358 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6359 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6360 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6361 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6362 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6363 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6364 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6365 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6366 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6367 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6368 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6369 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6370 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6371 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006372 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6373 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006374
6375 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6376 and "fd@2", see above.
6377
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006378 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6379 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6380 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6381 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6382 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6383 having the logs instantly available.
6384
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006385 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6386 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006387
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006388 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6389 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6390 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6391 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6392 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6393 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6394 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6395 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6396 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6397 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006398 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006399
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006400 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6401 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6402 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6403 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6404 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6405
6406 <sample_size>
6407 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6408 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6409 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6410 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6411 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6412
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006413 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6414 one of the following :
6415
6416 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6417 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6418
6419 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6420 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6421
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006422 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6423 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6424 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6425 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6426 systemd logger consumes.
6427
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006428 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6429 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6430 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6431 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6432
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006433 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6434
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006435 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6436 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6437 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6438
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006439 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6440 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6441 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6442 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006443
6444 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6445 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6446 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006447 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6448 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6449 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6450 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6451 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006452
6453 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6454
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006455 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6456 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6457 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006458
6459 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6460 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6461 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6462 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6463
6464 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6465 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006466
6467 Example :
6468 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006469 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6470 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6471 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006472 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6473 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006474 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006475
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006476
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006477log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006478 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6479 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6480 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006481
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006482 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6483 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6484 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6485 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6486 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006487
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006488 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6489 "option httplog" directives.
6490
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006491log-format-sd <string>
6492 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6493 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6494 yes | yes | yes | no
6495
6496 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6497 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6498 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6499 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6500 which covers the log format string in depth.
6501
6502 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6503 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6504
6505 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6506 log format to "rfc5424".
6507
6508 Example :
6509 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6510
6511
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006512log-tag <string>
6513 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6514 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6515 yes | yes | yes | yes
6516
6517 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6518 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6519 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6520 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6521 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6522 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6523 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6524 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6525 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006526
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006527max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6528 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6529 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6530 yes | no | yes | yes
6531
6532 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6533 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6534 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6535 servers.
6536
6537 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6538 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6539 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6540 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6541 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006542 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006543 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6544 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6545 picking a different server.
6546
6547 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6548 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6549 even if they have to be queued.
6550
6551 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6552 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6553
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006554max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6555 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6556 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6557 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006558
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006559maxconn <conns>
6560 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6562 yes | yes | yes | no
6563 Arguments :
6564 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6565 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6566 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6567 closes.
6568
6569 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6570 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6571 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6572 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006573 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6574 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6575 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6576 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006577
6578 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6579 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6580 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6581
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006582 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6583 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006584
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006585 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6586
6587
6588mode { tcp|http|health }
6589 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6591 yes | yes | yes | yes
6592 Arguments :
6593 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6594 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6595 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6596 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6597
6598 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6599 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6600 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6601 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6602 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6603
6604 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006605 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6606 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6607 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6608 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6609 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6610 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6611 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006612
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006613 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6614 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6615 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006616
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006617 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006618 defaults http_instances
6619 mode http
6620
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006621 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006622
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006623
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006624monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006625 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6627 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006628 Arguments :
6629 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6630 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006631 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006632 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6633 backend and its backup.
6634
6635 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6636 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6637 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6638 servers in a list of backends.
6639
6640 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6641 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6642 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6643 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6644 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6645 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6646 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006647 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6648 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006649
6650 Example:
6651 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006652 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006653 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6654 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6655 monitor-uri /site_alive
6656 monitor fail if site_dead
6657
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006658 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006659
6660
6661monitor-net <source>
6662 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6664 yes | yes | yes | no
6665 Arguments :
6666 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6667 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6668 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6669 followed by a mask.
6670
6671 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6672 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006673 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006674 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6675
6676 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6677 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6678 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6679 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006680 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6681 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6682 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006683
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006684 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6685 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6686 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6687 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6688 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6689 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006690
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006691 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6692 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006693
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006694 Example :
6695 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6696 frontend www
6697 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6698
6699 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6700
6701
6702monitor-uri <uri>
6703 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6705 yes | yes | yes | no
6706 Arguments :
6707 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6708 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6709
6710 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6711 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6712 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6713 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6714 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6715 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6716 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6717 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6718
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006719 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006720 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6721 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6722 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6723 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6724 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6725 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006726
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006727 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6728 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6729 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6730 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006732 Example :
6733 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6734 frontend www
6735 mode http
6736 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6737
6738 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6739
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006740
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006741option abortonclose
6742no option abortonclose
6743 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6745 yes | no | yes | yes
6746 Arguments : none
6747
6748 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6749 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6750 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6751 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006752 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006753 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6754 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6755 encountered while delivering the response.
6756
6757 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6758 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6759 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6760 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6761 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6762 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006763 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006764 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006765 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006766 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6767 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6768 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006770 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6771 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006772 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6773 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6774 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6775 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6776 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6777 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006778 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006779
6780 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6781 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6782
6783 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6784
6785
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006786option accept-invalid-http-request
6787no option accept-invalid-http-request
6788 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6790 yes | yes | yes | no
6791 Arguments : none
6792
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006793 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006794 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006795 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006796 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6797 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6798 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6799 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6800 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006801 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6802 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6803 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6804 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006805 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006806 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006807 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6808 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6809 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006810
6811 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6812 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6813 been confirmed.
6814
6815 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6816 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006817 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6818 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006819 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6820
6821 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6822 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6823
6824 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6825 stats socket.
6826
6827
6828option accept-invalid-http-response
6829no option accept-invalid-http-response
6830 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6832 yes | no | yes | yes
6833 Arguments : none
6834
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006835 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006836 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006837 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006838 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6839 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6840 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6841 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6842 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006843 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6844 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6845 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006846
6847 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6848 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6849 been confirmed.
6850
6851 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6852 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6853 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6854 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6855
6856 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6857 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6858
6859 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6860 stats socket.
6861
6862
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006863option allbackups
6864no option allbackups
6865 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6867 yes | no | yes | yes
6868 Arguments : none
6869
6870 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6871 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6872 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6873 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6874 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6875 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6876 order between the backup servers anymore.
6877
6878 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6879 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6880
6881 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6882 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6883
6884
6885option checkcache
6886no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006887 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6889 yes | no | yes | yes
6890 Arguments : none
6891
6892 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6893 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006894 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006895 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6896 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006897 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006898
6899 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006900 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006901 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006902 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6903 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006904 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006905 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006906 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6907 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006908 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006909 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6910 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006911 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006912 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6913 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6914 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6915 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6916 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6917 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6918 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6919 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6920 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6921
6922 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006923 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6924 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6925 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6926 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006927
6928 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6929 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006930 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006931 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006932
6933 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6934 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6935
6936
6937option clitcpka
6938no option clitcpka
6939 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6941 yes | yes | yes | no
6942 Arguments : none
6943
6944 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6945 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006946 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006947 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6948
6949 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6950 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6951 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6952 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6953
6954 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6955 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6956 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6957 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6958 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6959
6960 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6961
6962 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6963 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6964 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6965
6966 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6967 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6968
6969 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6970
6971
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006972option contstats
6973 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6975 yes | yes | yes | no
6976 Arguments : none
6977
6978 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6979 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6980 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6981 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006982 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6983 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6984 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6985 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6986 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006987
6988
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006989option dontlog-normal
6990no option dontlog-normal
6991 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6993 yes | yes | yes | no
6994 Arguments : none
6995
6996 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6997 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6998 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6999 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7000 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7001 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7002 logged.
7003
7004 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7005 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7006 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007008 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007009 logging.
7010
7011
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007012option dontlognull
7013no option dontlognull
7014 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7016 yes | yes | yes | no
7017 Arguments : none
7018
7019 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7020 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7021 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7022 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7023 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7024 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007025 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7026 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7027 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007028
7029 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007030 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007031 would not be logged.
7032
7033 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7034 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7035
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007036 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7037 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007038
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007039
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007040option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007041 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7043 yes | yes | yes | yes
7044 Arguments :
7045 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7046 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007047 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007048 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007049
7050 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7051 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7052 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7053 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7054 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7055 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7056 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007057 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7058 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7059 possible that the client has already brought one.
7060
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007061 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007062 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007063 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007064 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007065 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007066 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007067
7068 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7069 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7070 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7071 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7072 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7073 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7074 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7075
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007076 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7077 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7078 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7079 are under the control of the end-user.
7080
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007081 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007082 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7083 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007084 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7085 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7086 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007087
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007088 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007089 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7090 frontend www
7091 mode http
7092 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7093
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007094 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7095 backend www
7096 mode http
7097 option forwardfor header X-Client
7098
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007099 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007100 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007101
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007102
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007103option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7104no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7105 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7107 yes | yes | yes | no
7108 Arguments : none
7109
7110 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7111 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7112 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7113 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7114 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7115 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7116 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7117
7118 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7119 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7120 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7121 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7122 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7123 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7124 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7125 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7126 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7127 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7128
7129 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7130
7131 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7132 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7133
7134 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7135 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7136
7137
7138option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7139no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7140 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7142 yes | no | yes | yes
7143 Arguments : none
7144
7145 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7146 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7147 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7148 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7149 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7150 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7151 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7152
7153 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7154 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7155 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7156 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7157 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7158 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7159 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7160 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7161 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7162 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7163
7164 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7165
7166 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7167 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7168
7169 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7170 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7171
7172
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007173option http-buffer-request
7174no option http-buffer-request
7175 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7177 yes | yes | yes | yes
7178 Arguments : none
7179
7180 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7181 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7182 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7183 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7184 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7185 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007186 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7187 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7188 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7189 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007190
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007191 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007192
7193
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007194option http-ignore-probes
7195no option http-ignore-probes
7196 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7198 yes | yes | yes | no
7199 Arguments : none
7200
7201 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7202 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7203 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7204 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7205 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7206 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7207 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7208 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7209 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007210 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7211 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007212 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7213
7214 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7215 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7216 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7217 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7218 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7219 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7220 are often the only way to detect them.
7221
7222 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7223 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7224
7225 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7226
7227
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007228option http-keep-alive
7229no option http-keep-alive
7230 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7232 yes | yes | yes | yes
7233 Arguments : none
7234
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007235 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7236 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007237 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7238 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007239 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7240 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7241 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007242
7243 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7244 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007245 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7246 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7247 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7248 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7249 situations where this option may be useful :
7250
7251 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007252 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007253
7254 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7255 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7256
7257 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7258 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7259 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7260 request.
7261
7262 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7263 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007264 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7265 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7266 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007267
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007268 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7269 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7270 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7271 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7272 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7273 not set.
7274
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007275 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7276 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7277 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007278
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007279 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007280 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007281 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007282
7283
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007284option http-no-delay
7285no option http-no-delay
7286 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7288 yes | yes | yes | yes
7289 Arguments : none
7290
7291 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7292 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7293 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7294 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7295 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7296 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7297 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7298 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7299 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7300 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7301 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7302 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7303 affected.
7304
7305 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7306 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7307 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7308 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7309 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7310 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7311 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7312 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7313 latency environments.
7314
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007315 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7316
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007317
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007318option http-pretend-keepalive
7319no option http-pretend-keepalive
7320 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007322 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007323 Arguments : none
7324
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007325 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007326 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7327 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7328 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7329 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7330 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7331 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7332 consider the response complete.
7333
7334 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7335 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7336 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7337 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007338 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007339 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7340
7341 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7342 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7343 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7344 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7345 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7346 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7347 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7348
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007349 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7350 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7351 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7352 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7353 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7354 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007355
7356 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7357 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7358
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007359 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007360 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007361
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007362
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007363option http-server-close
7364no option http-server-close
7365 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7367 yes | yes | yes | yes
7368 Arguments : none
7369
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007370 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7371 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7372 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7373 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007374 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7375 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7376 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7377 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7378 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7379 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7380 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7381 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7382 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7383 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7384 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007385
7386 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7387 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7388 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7389 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007390 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7391 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007392
7393 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7394 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007395 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7396 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7397 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007398
7399 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7400 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7401
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007402 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7403 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007404
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007405option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007406no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007407 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7409 yes | yes | yes | no
7410 Arguments : none
7411
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007412 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007413 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7414 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7415 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7416 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7417 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7418 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7419
7420 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7421 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007422 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7423 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7424 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007425
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007426 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7427 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7428 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7429 front of an existing proxy.
7430
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007431 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7432
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007433 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007434
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007435option httpchk
7436option httpchk <uri>
7437option httpchk <method> <uri>
7438option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007439 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7441 yes | no | yes | yes
7442 Arguments :
7443 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7444 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7445 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7446 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7447 ones.
7448
7449 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7450 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7451 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7452
7453 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7454 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7455 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007456 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007457
7458 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7459 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7460 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7461 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7462 the lack of any response.
7463
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007464 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7465 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7466 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7467 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7468
7469 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7470 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7471 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007472
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007473 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7474 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007475 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
7476 internally relies on an HTX mutliplexer. Thus, it means the request
7477 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007478
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007479 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7480 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7481 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7482 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7483
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007484 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007485 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7486 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7487 backend https_relay
7488 mode tcp
7489 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7490 http-check send hdr Host www
7491 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007492
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007493 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7494 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7495 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007496
7497
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007498option httpclose
7499no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007500 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7502 yes | yes | yes | yes
7503 Arguments : none
7504
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007505 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7506 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7507 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7508 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007509 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007510
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007511 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7512 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007513 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007514 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7515 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007516
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007517 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7518 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7519 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007520
7521 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7522 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007523 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7524 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7525 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007526
7527 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7528 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7529
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007530 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007531
7532
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007533option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007534 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007536 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007537 Arguments :
7538 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7539 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7540 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007541 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007542 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007543
7544 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7545 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7546 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7547 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7548 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7549 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7550 ports.
7551
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007552 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7553 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007554
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007555 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007557 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007558
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007559
7560option http_proxy
7561no option http_proxy
7562 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7564 yes | yes | yes | yes
7565 Arguments : none
7566
7567 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7568 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7569 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7570 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7571 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7572
7573 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7574 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007575 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7576 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007577
7578 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7579 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7580
7581 Example :
7582 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7583 backend direct_forward
7584 option httpclose
7585 option http_proxy
7586
7587 See also : "option httpclose"
7588
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007589
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007590option independent-streams
7591no option independent-streams
7592 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7594 yes | yes | yes | yes
7595 Arguments : none
7596
7597 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7598 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7599 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7600 receive data or not.
7601
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007602 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007603 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7604 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7605 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7606 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7607 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7608 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7609 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7610 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7611 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7612 socket buffers.
7613
7614 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7615 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7616 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7617 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7618 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7619
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007620 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007621
7622
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007623option ldap-check
7624 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7626 yes | no | yes | yes
7627 Arguments : none
7628
7629 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7630 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7631 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7632 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7633
7634 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7635 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7636
7637 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7638 configure it.
7639
7640 Example :
7641 option ldap-check
7642
7643 See also : "option httpchk"
7644
7645
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007646option external-check
7647 Use external processes for server health checks
7648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7649 yes | no | yes | yes
7650
7651 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7652 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7653 command".
7654
7655 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7656
7657 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7658
7659
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007660option log-health-checks
7661no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007662 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7664 yes | no | yes | yes
7665 Arguments : none
7666
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007667 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7668 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7669 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007670
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007671 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7672 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7673 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7674 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7675 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7676
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007677 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007678 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007679
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007680 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7681 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7682 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007683
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007684
7685option log-separate-errors
7686no option log-separate-errors
7687 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7689 yes | yes | yes | no
7690 Arguments : none
7691
7692 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7693 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7694 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7695 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7696 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7697 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7698 provides very important information.
7699
7700 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7701 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7702 error logs.
7703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007704 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007705 logging.
7706
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007707
7708option logasap
7709no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007710 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7712 yes | yes | yes | no
7713 Arguments : none
7714
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007715 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7716 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7717 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7718 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7719
7720 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7721 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7722 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7723 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7724 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007725 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007726 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7727 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7728 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7729 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007730 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007731
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007732 Examples :
7733 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7734 mode http
7735 option httplog
7736 option logasap
7737 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7738
7739 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7740 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7741 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7742 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7743
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007744 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007745 logging.
7746
7747
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007748option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007749 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7751 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007752 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007753 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7754 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007755 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007756
7757 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7758 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007759 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007760 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7761 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7762 in the MySQL table, like this :
7763
7764 USE mysql;
7765 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7766 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7767
7768 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007769 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007770 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7771 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7772 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7773 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7774 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7775 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7776 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7777
7778 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7779 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007780
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007781 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007782
7783 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7784 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7785 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7786 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007787 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7788 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007789
7790 See also: "option httpchk"
7791
7792
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007793option nolinger
7794no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007795 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007796 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7797 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007798 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007799
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007800 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007801 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7802 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7803 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7804 connections.
7805
7806 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7807 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7808 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7809 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7810 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7811 this too.
7812
7813 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7814 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7815 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7816
7817 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7818 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7819 for servers.
7820
7821 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7822 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7823
7824
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007825option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7826 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7828 yes | yes | yes | yes
7829 Arguments :
7830 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7831 matching <network>
7832 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7833 header name.
7834
7835 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7836 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7837 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7838 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7839 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7840 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7841 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7842 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7843 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7844 possible that the client has already brought one.
7845
7846 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7847 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7848 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7849 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7850 header and requires different one.
7851
7852 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7853 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7854 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7855 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7856 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7857 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7858 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7859
7860 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7861 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7862 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7863 both are defined.
7864
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007865 Examples :
7866 # Original Destination address
7867 frontend www
7868 mode http
7869 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7870
7871 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7872 backend www
7873 mode http
7874 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7875
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007876 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007877
7878
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007879option persist
7880no option persist
7881 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7882 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7883 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007884 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007885
7886 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7887 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7888 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7889 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7890 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7891 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7892 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7893 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7894 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7895 redirected to another valid server.
7896
7897 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7898 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7899
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007900 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007901
7902
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007903option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7904 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7906 yes | no | yes | yes
7907 Arguments :
7908 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7909 PostgreSQL server.
7910
7911 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7912 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7913 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7914 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7915
7916 See also: "option httpchk"
7917
7918
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007919option prefer-last-server
7920no option prefer-last-server
7921 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7922 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7923 yes | no | yes | yes
7924 Arguments : none
7925
7926 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7927 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7928 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7929 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7930 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7931 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7932 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7933 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7934 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007935 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7936 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007937 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7938 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7939 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007940 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7941 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7942 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007943
7944 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7945 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7946
7947 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7948
7949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007950option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007951option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007952no option redispatch
7953 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7954 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7955 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007956 Arguments :
7957 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7958 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7959 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007960 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007961 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007962 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007963 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7964 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7965 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7966
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007967
7968 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7969 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7970 be able to access the service anymore.
7971
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007972 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7973 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007974
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02007975 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
7976 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
7977 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
7978 following order:
7979
7980 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
7981
7982 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
7983 list, or
7984
7985 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
7986
7987 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
7988 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
7989
7990 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
7991 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
7992 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
7993 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
7994
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007995 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007996 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7997 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007998
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007999 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8000 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8001
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008002 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008003
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008004
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008005option redis-check
8006 Use redis health checks for server testing
8007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8008 yes | no | yes | yes
8009 Arguments : none
8010
8011 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8012 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8013 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8014 find the "+PONG" response message.
8015
8016 Example :
8017 option redis-check
8018
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008019 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008020
8021
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008022option smtpchk
8023option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8024 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8026 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008027 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008028 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008029 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008030 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8031
8032 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8033 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8034 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8035
8036 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8037 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8038 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8039 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8040 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8041 dead server.
8042
8043 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8044 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008045 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008046 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8047
8048 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8049 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8050 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8051 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008052 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008053
8054 Example :
8055 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8056
8057 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8058
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008059
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008060option socket-stats
8061no option socket-stats
8062
8063 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8065 yes | yes | yes | no
8066
8067 Arguments : none
8068
8069
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008070option splice-auto
8071no option splice-auto
8072 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8074 yes | yes | yes | yes
8075 Arguments : none
8076
8077 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8078 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008079 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008080 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008081 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008082 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8083 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8084 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8085 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8086
8087 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8088 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8089 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8090 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8091 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8092 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8093 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8094 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8095 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8096 keyword.
8097
8098 Example :
8099 option splice-auto
8100
8101 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8102 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8103
8104 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8105 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8106
8107
8108option splice-request
8109no option splice-request
8110 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8112 yes | yes | yes | yes
8113 Arguments : none
8114
8115 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008116 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008117 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8118 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8119 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8120 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8121
8122 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8123
8124 Example :
8125 option splice-request
8126
8127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8129
8130 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8131 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8132
8133
8134option splice-response
8135no option splice-response
8136 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8138 yes | yes | yes | yes
8139 Arguments : none
8140
8141 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008142 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008143 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8144 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8145 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8146 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8147
8148 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8149
8150 Example :
8151 option splice-response
8152
8153 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8154 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8155
8156 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8157 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8158
8159
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008160option spop-check
8161 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8163 no | no | no | yes
8164 Arguments : none
8165
8166 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8167 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8168 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8169 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8170
8171 Example :
8172 option spop-check
8173
8174 See also : "option httpchk"
8175
8176
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008177option srvtcpka
8178no option srvtcpka
8179 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8181 yes | no | yes | yes
8182 Arguments : none
8183
8184 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8185 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008186 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008187 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8188
8189 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8190 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8191 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8192 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8193
8194 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8195 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8196 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8197 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8198 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8199
8200 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8201
8202 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8203 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8204 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8205
8206 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8207 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8208
8209 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8210
8211
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008212option ssl-hello-chk
8213 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8215 yes | no | yes | yes
8216 Arguments : none
8217
8218 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8219 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8220 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8221 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8222 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8223 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8224 hello message.
8225
8226 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8227 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8228 messages, which is appreciable.
8229
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008230 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8231 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8232 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008233
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008234 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8235
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008236
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008237option tcp-check
8238 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8239 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8240 yes | no | yes | yes
8241
8242 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8243 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8244
8245 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8246 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8247 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8248
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008249 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008250 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8251 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8252 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8253 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8254 only.
8255
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008256 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008257 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8258 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8259 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8260 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8261
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008262 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008263 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8264 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008265 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008266 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8267 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8268 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8269 the respective protocols.
8270 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008271 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008272
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008273 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008274
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008275 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8276 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8277 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8278 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008279
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008280 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8281 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8282 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008283
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008284
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008285 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008286 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008287 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008288 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008289
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008290 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008291 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008292 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008293
8294 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8295 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008296 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008297 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008298 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008299 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008300 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008301 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008302 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8303 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008304 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008305 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8306 tcp-check expect string +OK
8307
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008308 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008309 (send many headers before analyzing)
8310 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008311 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008312 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8313 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8314 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8315 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008316 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008317
8318
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008319 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008320
8321
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008322option tcp-smart-accept
8323no option tcp-smart-accept
8324 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8326 yes | yes | yes | no
8327 Arguments : none
8328
8329 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8330 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8331 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8332 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8333 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8334 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8335
8336 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8337 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8338 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8339 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8340
8341 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8342 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8343 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008344 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008345
8346 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8347 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8348 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8349
8350 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8351 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8352 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8353
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008354 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8355
8356
8357option tcp-smart-connect
8358no option tcp-smart-connect
8359 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8361 yes | no | yes | yes
8362 Arguments : none
8363
8364 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8365 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8366 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8367 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8368 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8369
8370 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8371 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8372 complex.
8373
8374 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8375 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8376 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8377
8378 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8379 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8380
8381 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8382
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008383
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008384option tcpka
8385 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8387 yes | yes | yes | yes
8388 Arguments : none
8389
8390 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8391 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008392 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008393 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8394
8395 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8396 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8397 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8398 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8399
8400 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8401 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8402 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8403 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8404 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8405
8406 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8407
8408 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8409 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8410 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8411 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8412 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8413 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8414 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8415 backends.
8416
8417 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8418
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008419
8420option tcplog
8421 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008423 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008424 Arguments : none
8425
8426 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8427 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8428 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8429 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8430 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8431 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8432 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8433 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8434
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008435 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008437 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008438
8439
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008440option transparent
8441no option transparent
8442 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008444 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008445 Arguments : none
8446
8447 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8448 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8449 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8450 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8451 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8452 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8453 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8454 appropriate server.
8455
8456 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8457 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8458
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008459 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008460 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008461
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008462
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008463external-check command <command>
8464 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8466 yes | no | yes | yes
8467
8468 Arguments :
8469 <command> is the external command to run
8470
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008471 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8472
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008473 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008474
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008475 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8476 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8477 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8478 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8479 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8480 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008481
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008482 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8483
8484 Environment variables :
8485 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8486 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8487
8488 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8489
8490 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8491
8492 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8493 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8494 for a UNIX socket).
8495
8496 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8497
8498 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8499
8500 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8501
8502 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8503
8504 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8505
8506 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8507 socket).
8508
8509 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8510 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8511
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008512 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8513
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008514 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8515 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8516 failed.
8517
8518 Example :
8519 external-check command /bin/true
8520
8521 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8522
8523
8524external-check path <path>
8525 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8527 yes | no | yes | yes
8528
8529 Arguments :
8530 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8531
8532 The default path is "".
8533
8534 Example :
8535 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8536
8537 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8538 "external-check command"
8539
8540
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008541persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008542persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008543 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8545 yes | no | yes | yes
8546 Arguments :
8547 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008548 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8549 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008550
8551 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8552 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008553 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008554 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8555 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8556 forwarded to this server.
8557
8558 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8559 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8560 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008561 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008562 a single "listen" section.
8563
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008564 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8565 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8566 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8567
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008568 Example :
8569 listen tse-farm
8570 bind :3389
8571 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8572 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8573 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8574 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8575 persist rdp-cookie
8576 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008577 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008578 balance rdp-cookie
8579 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8580 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8581
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008582 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8583 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008584
8585
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008586rate-limit sessions <rate>
8587 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8589 yes | yes | yes | no
8590 Arguments :
8591 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8592 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8593
8594 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8595 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8596 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8597 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8598 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8599 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8600
8601 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8602 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8603 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8604 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8605
8606 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8607 listen smtp
8608 mode tcp
8609 bind :25
8610 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008611 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008612
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008613 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8614 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8615 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008616
8617 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8618
8619
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008620redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8621redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8622redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008623 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8625 no | yes | yes | yes
8626
8627 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008628 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008629
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008630 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008631 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008632 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8633 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8634 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008635
8636 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8637 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8638 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8639 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8640 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008641 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8642 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8643 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8644 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008645
8646 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8647 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8648 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8649 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8650 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8651 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008652 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008653 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008654 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8655 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8656 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008657
8658 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008659 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8660 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8661 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008662 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008663 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8664 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8665 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8666 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008667
8668 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008669 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008670
8671 - "drop-query"
8672 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8673 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8674 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8675 with a location-type redirect.
8676
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008677 - "append-slash"
8678 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8679 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8680 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8681 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8682
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008683 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8684 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8685 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8686 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8687 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8688 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8689 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8690
8691 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8692 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8693 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8694 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8695 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8696 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8697 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008698
8699 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8700 acl clear dst_port 80
8701 acl secure dst_port 8080
8702 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008703 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008704 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008705 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8706
8707 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008708 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8709 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8710 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008711 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008712
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008713 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8714 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8715 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8716
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008717 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008718 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008719
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008720 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008721 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8722 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8723 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008725 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008726
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008727
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008728retries <value>
8729 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8730 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8731 yes | no | yes | yes
8732 Arguments :
8733 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8734 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8735 default value is 3.
8736
8737 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8738 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8739 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8740
8741 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008742 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8743 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008744
8745 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8746 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8747
8748 See also : "option redispatch"
8749
8750
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008751retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02008752 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
8753 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
8754 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008755 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8756 yes | no | yes | yes
8757 Arguments :
8758 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8759 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8760 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8761 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8762
8763 none never retry
8764
8765 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8766 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8767
8768 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8769 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8770 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8771 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8772 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8773 processing the request.
8774
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008775 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8776 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8777 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8778 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8779 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8780 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8781 overflow attack for example).
8782
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008783 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8784 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8785 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8786 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8787 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8788 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8789 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8790 amplify denial of service attacks.
8791
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008792 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8793 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8794 considered to be safe to retry.
8795
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008796 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8797 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8798 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8799 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8800
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008801 all-retryable-errors
8802 retry request for any error that are considered
8803 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8804 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8805 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8806
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008807 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8808 not cumulative.
8809
8810 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8811 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8812 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8813 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8814
8815 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8816 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8817 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8818 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8819 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8820 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8821 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8822 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8823 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8824 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8825 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8826 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8827
8828 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8829 should not use this directive.
8830
8831 The default is "conn-failure".
8832
8833 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8834
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008835server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008836 Declare a server in a backend
8837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8838 no | no | yes | yes
8839 Arguments :
8840 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008841 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008842 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008843
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008844 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8845 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8846 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8847 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008848 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8849 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8850 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8851 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8852 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008853 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8854 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8855 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8856 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8857 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8858 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8859 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008860 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008861 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8862 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8863 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8864 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8865 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8866 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8868 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008869 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8870 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008871
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008872 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008873 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8874 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8875 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8876 adding this value to the client's port.
8877
8878 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8879 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008880 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008881
8882 Examples :
8883 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8884 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008885 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008886 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8887 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8888 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008889
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008890 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8891 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8892 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8893 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8894 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8895
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008896 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8897 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008898
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008899server-state-file-name [<file>]
8900 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8901 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8902 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8903 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8904 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8905 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8906
8907 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8908 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8909
8910 global
8911 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8912
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008913 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008914 load-server-state-from-file
8915
8916 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8917 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008918
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008919server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8920 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8921 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8923 no | no | yes | yes
8924
8925 Arguments:
8926 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8927
8928 <num | range>
8929 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8930 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8931 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8932 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8933
8934 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8935
8936 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8937
8938 <params*>
8939 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8940 keyword.
8941
8942 Examples:
8943 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8944 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8945 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8946
8947 # or
8948 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8949
8950 # would be equivalent to:
8951 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8952 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8953 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8954
8955
8956
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008957source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008958source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008959source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008960 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8962 yes | no | yes | yes
8963 Arguments :
8964 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8965 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008966
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008967 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008968 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8969 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8970 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8971 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8972 supported prefixes are :
8973 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8974 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8975 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008976 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008977 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8978 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008979
8980 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8981 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008982 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8983 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8984 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008985
8986 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8987 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8988 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8989 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8990 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8991 <addr>.
8992
8993 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8994 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8995 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8996 port.
8997
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008998 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8999 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9000 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9001 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009002 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009003 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9004 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9005 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9006 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9007 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9008 HTTP header.
9009
9010 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9011 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009012 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009013 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9014 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9015 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9016 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9017 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9018 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9019 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9020
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009021 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9022 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9023 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9024 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9025 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9026 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9027
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009028 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9029 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9030 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9031 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9032
9033 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9034 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9035 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9036 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9037 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9038 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9039
9040 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9041 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9042 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9043 there are two methods :
9044
9045 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9046 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9047 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9048 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9049 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9050 of the client ranges may be used.
9051
9052 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9053 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9054 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9055 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9056 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9057 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9058 same session.
9059
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009060 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9061 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9062 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009063 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009064
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009065 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9066
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009067 Examples :
9068 backend private
9069 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9070 source 192.168.1.200
9071
9072 backend transparent_ssl1
9073 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9074 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9075
9076 backend transparent_ssl2
9077 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9078 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9079 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9080
9081 backend transparent_ssl3
9082 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9083 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9084 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9085
9086 backend transparent_smtp
9087 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9088 # with Tproxy version 4.
9089 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9090
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009091 backend transparent_http
9092 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9093 # proxy.
9094 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009096 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009097 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9098
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009099
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009100stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9101 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009103 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009104
9105 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9106 matched.
9107
9108 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9109 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9110
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009111 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9112 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009113 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009114
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009115 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9116 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9117 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9118 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009119
9120 Example :
9121 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9122 backend stats_localhost
9123 stats enable
9124 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9125
9126 Example :
9127 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9128 backend stats_auth
9129 stats enable
9130 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9131 stats admin if TRUE
9132
9133 Example :
9134 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9135 userlist stats-auth
9136 group admin users admin
9137 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9138 group readonly users haproxy
9139 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9140
9141 backend stats_auth
9142 stats enable
9143 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9144 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9145 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9146 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9147
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009148 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9149 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9150 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009151
9152
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009153stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9154 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009156 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009157 Arguments :
9158 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9159
9160 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9161
9162 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9163 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9164 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9165 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9166 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9167 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9168
9169 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9170 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9171 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009172 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009173
9174 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9175 report using "stats scope".
9176
9177 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9178 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9179 unobvious parameters.
9180
9181 Example :
9182 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9183 backend public_www
9184 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9185 stats enable
9186 stats hide-version
9187 stats scope .
9188 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009189 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009190 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9191 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9192
9193 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9194 backend private_monitoring
9195 stats enable
9196 stats uri /admin?stats
9197 stats refresh 5s
9198
9199 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9200
9201
9202stats enable
9203 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009205 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009206 Arguments : none
9207
9208 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9209 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9210 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9211 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9212 - stats auth : no authentication
9213 - stats scope : no restriction
9214
9215 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9216 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9217 unobvious parameters.
9218
9219 Example :
9220 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9221 backend public_www
9222 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9223 stats enable
9224 stats hide-version
9225 stats scope .
9226 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009227 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009228 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9229 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9230
9231 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9232 backend private_monitoring
9233 stats enable
9234 stats uri /admin?stats
9235 stats refresh 5s
9236
9237 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9238
9239
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009240stats hide-version
9241 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009243 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009244 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009245
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009246 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9247 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9248 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9249 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9250 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9251 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009252
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009253 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9254 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9255 unobvious parameters.
9256
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009257 Example :
9258 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9259 backend public_www
9260 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009261 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009262 stats hide-version
9263 stats scope .
9264 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009265 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009266 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9267 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009268
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009269 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9270 backend private_monitoring
9271 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009272 stats uri /admin?stats
9273 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009274
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009275 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009276
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009277
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009278stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9279 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9280 Access control for statistics
9281
9282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9283 no | no | yes | yes
9284
9285 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9286 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9287 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9288 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9289 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9290 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9291
9292 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9293 instance.
9294
9295 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9296 about ACL usage.
9297
9298
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009299stats realm <realm>
9300 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009302 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009303 Arguments :
9304 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9305 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9306 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9307
9308 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9309 using a backslash ('\').
9310
9311 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9312 only related to authentication.
9313
9314 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9315 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9316 unobvious parameters.
9317
9318 Example :
9319 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9320 backend public_www
9321 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9322 stats enable
9323 stats hide-version
9324 stats scope .
9325 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009326 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009327 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9328 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9329
9330 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9331 backend private_monitoring
9332 stats enable
9333 stats uri /admin?stats
9334 stats refresh 5s
9335
9336 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9337
9338
9339stats refresh <delay>
9340 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009342 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009343 Arguments :
9344 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9345 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9346 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9347 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9348 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9349 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9350
9351 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9352 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9353 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9354 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9355
9356 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9357 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9358 unobvious parameters.
9359
9360 Example :
9361 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9362 backend public_www
9363 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9364 stats enable
9365 stats hide-version
9366 stats scope .
9367 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009368 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009369 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9370 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9371
9372 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9373 backend private_monitoring
9374 stats enable
9375 stats uri /admin?stats
9376 stats refresh 5s
9377
9378 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9379
9380
9381stats scope { <name> | "." }
9382 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009384 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009385 Arguments :
9386 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9387 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9388 section in which the statement appears.
9389
9390 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9391 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9392 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9393 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9394 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9395 exists.
9396
9397 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9398 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9399 unobvious parameters.
9400
9401 Example :
9402 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9403 backend public_www
9404 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9405 stats enable
9406 stats hide-version
9407 stats scope .
9408 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009409 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009410 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9411 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9412
9413 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9414 backend private_monitoring
9415 stats enable
9416 stats uri /admin?stats
9417 stats refresh 5s
9418
9419 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9420
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009421
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009422stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009423 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009425 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009426
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009427 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009428 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9429
9430 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9431 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9432
9433 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9434 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009435 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009436
9437 Example :
9438 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9439 backend private_monitoring
9440 stats enable
9441 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9442 stats uri /admin?stats
9443 stats refresh 5s
9444
9445 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9446 global section.
9447
9448
9449stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009450 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9452 yes | yes | yes | yes
9453 Arguments : none
9454
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009455 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009456 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9457 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9458 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9459 - IP (socket, server)
9460 - cookie (backend, server)
9461
9462 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9463 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009464 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009465
9466 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9467
9468
9469stats show-node [ <name> ]
9470 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009472 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009473 Arguments:
9474 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9475 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9476
9477 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9478 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009479 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009480
9481 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9482 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9483 unobvious parameters.
9484
9485 Example:
9486 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9487 backend private_monitoring
9488 stats enable
9489 stats show-node Europe-1
9490 stats uri /admin?stats
9491 stats refresh 5s
9492
9493 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9494 section.
9495
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009496
9497stats uri <prefix>
9498 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009500 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009501 Arguments :
9502 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9503 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9504 query string.
9505
9506 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9507 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9508 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9509 possible to reach it in the application.
9510
9511 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009512 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009513 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9514 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9515 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9516 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9517
9518 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9519 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9520 an address or a port to statistics only.
9521
9522 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9523 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9524 unobvious parameters.
9525
9526 Example :
9527 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9528 backend public_www
9529 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9530 stats enable
9531 stats hide-version
9532 stats scope .
9533 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009534 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009535 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9536 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9537
9538 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9539 backend private_monitoring
9540 stats enable
9541 stats uri /admin?stats
9542 stats refresh 5s
9543
9544 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9545
9546
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009547stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9548 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009550 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009551
9552 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009553 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009554 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009555 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009556 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9557
9558 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9559 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9560 the "stick-table" statement.
9561
9562 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9563 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9564 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9565 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9566 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9567
9568 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9569 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9570 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9571 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9572 transformation rules.
9573
9574 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9575 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9576 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9577 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9578 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9579 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9580 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9581
9582 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9583 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9584 ACL based conditions.
9585
9586 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9587 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9588 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9589 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9590
9591 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9592 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9593 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9594 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9595
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009596 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9597 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009598 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009599
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009600 Example :
9601 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9602 # last 30 minutes
9603 backend pop
9604 mode tcp
9605 balance roundrobin
9606 stick store-request src
9607 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9608 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9609 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9610
9611 backend smtp
9612 mode tcp
9613 balance roundrobin
9614 stick match src table pop
9615 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9616 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9617
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009618 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009619 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009620
9621
9622stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9623 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9625 no | no | yes | yes
9626
9627 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9628 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9629 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9630 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9631
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009632 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9633 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009634 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009635
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009636 Examples :
9637 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009638 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009639
9640 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9641 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9642 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9643
9644
9645 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9646 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9647 backend http
9648 mode http
9649 balance roundrobin
9650 stick on src table https
9651 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9652 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9653 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9654
9655 backend https
9656 mode tcp
9657 balance roundrobin
9658 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9659 stick on src
9660 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9661 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9662
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009663 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009664
9665
9666stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9667 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9669 no | no | yes | yes
9670
9671 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009672 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009673 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009674 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009675 server is selected.
9676
9677 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9678 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9679 the "stick-table" statement.
9680
9681 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9682 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9683 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9684 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9685 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9686 address.
9687
9688 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9689 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9690 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9691 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9692 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9693 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9694 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9695 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9696 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9697 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9698
9699 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9700 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9701 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9702 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9703 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9704 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9705 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9706
9707 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9708 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9709 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9710 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9711
9712 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9713 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9714 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9715 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9716 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9717 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009718 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9719 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9720 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9721 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9722 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9723 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009724
9725 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9726 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9727 the request.
9728
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009729 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9730 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009731 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009732
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009733 Example :
9734 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9735 # last 30 minutes
9736 backend pop
9737 mode tcp
9738 balance roundrobin
9739 stick store-request src
9740 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9741 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9742 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9743
9744 backend smtp
9745 mode tcp
9746 balance roundrobin
9747 stick match src table pop
9748 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9749 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9750
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009751 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009752 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009753
9754
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009755stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009756 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9757 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009758 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009760 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009761
9762 Arguments :
9763 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9764 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9765 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9766 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9767
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009768 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9769 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9770 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9771 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9772
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009773 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9774 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9775 instance.
9776
9777 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9778 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9779 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9780 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9781 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9782 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009783 to 32 characters.
9784
9785 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9786 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9787 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009788 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009789 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9790 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009791
9792 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009793 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9794 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009795 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9796 increase.
9797
9798 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009799 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9800 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9801 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009802
9803 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9804 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9805 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9806 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009807 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009808 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9809 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9810 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9811 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9812 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9813 parameter (see below).
9814
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009815 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9816 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9817 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9818 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9819 soft restart.
9820
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009821 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9822 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009823
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009824 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9825 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9826 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9827 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009828 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009829 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009830 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9831 if not expiration delay is specified.
9832
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009833 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9834 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9835 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9836 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009837 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9838 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9839 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9840 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9841 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9842 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9843 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9844 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9845 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9846 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9847 types and their arguments.
9848
9849 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9850 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9851 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9852 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9853
9854 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9855 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9856 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009857 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009858
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009859 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9860 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9861 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009862 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009863 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009864 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009865
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009866 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9867 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9868 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9869 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9870
9871 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9872 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9873 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9874 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9875 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9876 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9877
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009878 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9879 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9880 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9881 they were received.
9882
9883 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9884 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9885 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9886 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9887 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9888
9889 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9890 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9891 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9892 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9893 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9894
9895 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9896 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9897 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9898
9899 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9900 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9901 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9902 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9903 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9904
9905 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9906 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9907 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9908 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9909 the client side.
9910
9911 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9912 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9913 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9914 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9915 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9916 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9917 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9918
9919 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9920 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9921 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9922 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9923 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9924 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009925 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009926
9927 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9928 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9929 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9930 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9931 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9932 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9933
9934 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009935 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009936 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9937 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9938
9939 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9940 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9941 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9942 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9943 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9944 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9945 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9946 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9947 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9948 recommended for better fairness.
9949
9950 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009951 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009952 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9953 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9954
9955 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9956 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9957 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9958 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9959 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9960 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9961 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9962 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9963 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9964 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009965
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009966 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9967 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009968 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9969 reference it.
9970
9971 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9972 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009973 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9974 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9975 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009976
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009977 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9978 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9979 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9980 something that can be ignored.
9981
9982 Example:
9983 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9984 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9985 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9986 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9987
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009988 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009989 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009990
9991
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009992stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009993 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9995 no | no | yes | yes
9996
9997 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009998 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009999 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010000 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010001 server is selected.
10002
10003 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10004 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10005 the "stick-table" statement.
10006
10007 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10008 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10009 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10010 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10011
10012 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10013 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10014 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10015 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10016 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10017 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010018 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010019 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10020 rules.
10021
10022 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10023 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10024 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10025 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10026 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10027 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10028 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10029
10030 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10031 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10032 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10033 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10034
10035 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10036 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10037 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10038 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10039 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10040 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010041 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10042 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10043 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10044 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10045 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10046 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10047 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10048 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10049 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010050
10051 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10052
10053 Example :
10054 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10055 backend https
10056 mode tcp
10057 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010058 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010059 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010060
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010061 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10062 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10063
10064 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10065 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10066 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10067
10068 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10069 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010070
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010071 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10072 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10073 # at offset 44.
10074
10075 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10076 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10077
10078 # Learn on response if server hello.
10079 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010080
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010081 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10082 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10083
10084 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10085 extraction.
10086
10087
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010088tcp-check comment <string>
10089 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10090 it fails.
10091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10092 yes | no | yes | yes
10093
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010094 Arguments :
10095 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10096 rule fails.
10097
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010098 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10099 user-friendly error reporting.
10100
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010101 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10102 "tcp-check expect".
10103
10104
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010105tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10106 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010107 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010108 Opens a new connection
10109 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010110 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010111
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010112 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010113 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10114
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010115 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Christopher Fauletbb591a12020-04-01 16:52:17 +020010116 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010117
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010118 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010119 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10120 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010121 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010122
10123 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010124
10125 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10126
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010127 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10128
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010129 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10130
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010131 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10132
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010133 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10134 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10135 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10136 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10137
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010138 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10139 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10140 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10141 haproxy -vv.
10142
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010143 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010144
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010145 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10146 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10147 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10148
10149 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10150 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10151 of the sequence.
10152
10153 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10154 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10155 do.
10156
10157 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10158 unset-var or comment rules.
10159
10160 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010161 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10162 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10163 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10164 option tcp-check
10165 tcp-check connect
10166 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10167 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10168 tcp-check send \r\n
10169 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10170 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10171 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10172 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10173 tcp-check send \r\n
10174 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10175 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10176
10177 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10178 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010179 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010180 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10181 tcp-check connect port 143
10182 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10183 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10184
10185 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10186
10187
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010188tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010189 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010190 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010191 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010192 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010193 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010194 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010195
10196 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010197 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10198
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010199 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10200 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10201 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10202 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10203 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10204 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10205 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10206 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10207 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10208 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10209
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010210 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010211 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10212 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010213 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10214 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10215 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10216
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010217 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10218 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10219 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010220 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10221 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10222 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10223 example 404 with disable-on-404
10224 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10225 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010226 By default "L7OK" is used.
10227
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010228 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10229 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010230 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10231 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10232 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10233 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10234 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10235 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010236
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010237 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010238 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010239 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10240 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10241 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10242 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010243 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10244
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010245 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10246 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10247 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10248 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10249
10250 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10251 informational message reported in logs if an error
10252 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10253 log-format string.
10254
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010255 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10256 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10257 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10258 followed by some converters.
10259
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010260 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10261 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10262 with the usual backslash ('\').
10263 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010264 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010265 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10266 used upper or lower case.
10267
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010268 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10269
10270 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10271 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10272 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10273 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10274 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10275 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10276 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10277 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10278
10279 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10280 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10281 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10282 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10283 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10284 expression.
10285
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010286 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10287 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10288 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10289 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10290 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10291 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10292
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010293 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10294 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10295 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10296 this exact hexadecimal string.
10297 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10298
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010299 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10300 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10301 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10302 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10303 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10304 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10305 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10306 size.
10307
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010308 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10309 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10310 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10311 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10312 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10313 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10314 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10315 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10316 in a binary string before matching the response's
10317 buffer.
10318
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010319 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10320 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10321 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10322 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10323 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10324 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10325 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10326 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10327 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10328 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10329 the null character.
10330
10331 Examples :
10332 # perform a POP check
10333 option tcp-check
10334 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10335
10336 # perform an IMAP check
10337 option tcp-check
10338 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10339
10340 # look for the redis master server
10341 option tcp-check
10342 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010343 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010344 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10345 tcp-check expect string role:master
10346 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10347 tcp-check expect string +OK
10348
10349
10350 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10351 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10352
10353
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010354tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10355tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10356 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10357 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010358 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010359 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010360
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010361 Arguments :
10362 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10363
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010364 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10365 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010366
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010367 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10368 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010369
10370 Examples :
10371 # look for the redis master server
10372 option tcp-check
10373 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10374 tcp-check expect string role:master
10375
10376 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10377 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10378
10379
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010380tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10381tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10382 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10383 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010384 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010385 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010386
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010387 Arguments :
10388 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010389
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010390 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10391 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010392
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010393 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10394 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10395 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010396
10397 Examples :
10398 # redis check in binary
10399 option tcp-check
10400 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10401 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10402
10403
10404 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10405 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10406
10407
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010408tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010409 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010410 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010411 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010412
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010413 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010414 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10415 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10416 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10417 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10418 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10419 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10420 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10421 and '-'.
10422
10423 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10424
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010425 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010426 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10427
10428
10429tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010430 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010431 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010432 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010433
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010434 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010435 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10436 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10437 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10438 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10439 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10440 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10441 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10442 and '-'.
10443
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010444 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010445 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10446
10447
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010448tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10449 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10451 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010452 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010453 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10454 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010455
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010456 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010457
10458 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10459 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010460 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10461 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10462 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10463 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10464 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10465 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010466
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010467 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10468 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10469 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10470 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010471
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010472 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010473 - accept :
10474 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10475 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10476 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010477
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010478 - reject :
10479 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10480 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10481 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10482 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10483 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10484 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10485 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10486 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10487 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10488 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10489 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010490 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010491
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010492 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10493 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10494 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10495 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10496 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10497 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10498 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10499 hosts.
10500
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010501 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10502 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10503 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10504 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10505 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10506 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10507 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10508 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10509
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010510 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10511 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10512 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10513 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10514 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10515 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10516 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10517 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10518 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010519 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10520 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010521
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010522 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010523 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010524 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10525 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10526 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010527 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010528 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10529 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10530 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10531 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10532 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10533 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10534 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10535 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010536
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010537 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010538 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010539 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010540 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010541 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10542 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10543 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010544
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010545 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10546 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10547 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10548 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010549
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010550 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10551 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10552 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10553 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10554 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010555 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10556 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10557 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10558 layer7 information is extracted.
10559
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010560 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10561 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10562 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10563 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10564 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010565
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010566 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10567 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10568 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10569 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10570
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010571 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10572 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10573 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10574 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10575
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010576 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10577 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10578 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10579 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10580 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010581
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010582 - set-src <expr> :
10583 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10584 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10585 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010586 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010587
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010588 Arguments:
10589 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10590 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010591
10592 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010593 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10594
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010595 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10596 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010597
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010598 - set-src-port <expr> :
10599 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10600 expression.
10601
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010602 Arguments:
10603 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10604 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010605
10606 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010607 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10608
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010609 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10610 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10611 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010612
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010613 - set-dst <expr> :
10614 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10615 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10616 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10617 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10618 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10619
10620 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10621 followed by some converters.
10622
10623 Example:
10624
10625 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10626 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10627
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010628 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10629 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10630
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010631 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10632 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10633 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10634 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10635
10636
10637 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10638 followed by some converters.
10639
10640 Example:
10641
10642 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10643
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010644 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10645 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10646 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10647
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010648 - "silent-drop" :
10649 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010650 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010651 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10652 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10653 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10654 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10655 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010656 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10657 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010658 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10659 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010660 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010661 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10662 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10663 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10664 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10665
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010666 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10667 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10668 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010669
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010670 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10671 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10672 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010673
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010674 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010675 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010676 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010677
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010678 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10679 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10680 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010681
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010682 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010683 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10684 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010685
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010686 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10687
10688 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10689
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010690 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10691
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010692 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010693
10694
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010695tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10696 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010698 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010699 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010700 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10701 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010702
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010703 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010704
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010705 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010706 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10707 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10708 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10709 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010710
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010711 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10712 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10713 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10714 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010715 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10716 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10717 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10718 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10719 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10720 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010721 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010722 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010723
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010724 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10725 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10726 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10727 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010728
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010729 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010730 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010731 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010732 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10733 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010734 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010735 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010736 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010737 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010738 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010739 - set-dst <expr>
10740 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010741 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010742 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010743 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010744 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010745 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010746
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010747 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10748 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010749 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10750 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010751
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010752 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10753 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10754 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10755 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10756 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10757 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010758
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010759 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010760 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10761 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010762
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010763 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010764 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10765 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10766 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10767 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010768 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10769 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10770 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010771
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010772 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010773 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10774 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10775 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010776
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010777 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10778 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10779
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010780 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010781 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10782 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010783
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010784 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10785 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010786 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010787 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10788 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010789 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010790 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010791 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010792 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10793 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010794 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010795 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10796 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010797
10798 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10799 followed by some converters.
10800
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010801 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10802 <var-name>.
10803
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010804 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10805 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10806 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10807 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10808 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10809
10810 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10811 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10812 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10813 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10814 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10815 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10816 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10817 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10818 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10819 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10820 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10821
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010822 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10823 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10824 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10825 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10826 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10827
10828 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10829
10830 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10831
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010832 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10833 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10834 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10835 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10836 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10837 evaluated.
10838
10839 Example:
10840 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10841
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010842 Example:
10843
10844 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010845 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010846
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010847 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010848 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10849 # and reject everything else.
10850 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10851 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010852 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010853 tcp-request content reject
10854
10855 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010856 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10857 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10858 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010859 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010860
10861 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10862 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10863 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010864 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010865 tcp-request content reject
10866
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010867 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010868 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010869 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010870 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010871 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10872 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010873
10874 Example:
10875 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10876 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010877 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010878
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010879 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010880 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010881
10882 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010883 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010884 # protecting all our sites
10885 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010886 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10887 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010888 ...
10889 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10890
10891 backend http_dynamic
10892 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010893 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010894 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010895 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010896 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010897 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010898 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010899
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010900 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010901
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010902 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10903 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010904
10905
10906tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10907 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010909 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010910 Arguments :
10911 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10912 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10913 as explained at the top of this document.
10914
10915 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10916 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10917 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10918 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10919 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10920
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010921 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10922 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10923 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10924 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10925
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010926 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10927 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010928 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010929 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010930 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10931 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10932 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10933 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010934
10935 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10936 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10937 it pass through unaffected.
10938
10939 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10940 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10941 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010942 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010943 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10944 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010945 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10946 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10947 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010948
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010949 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010950 "timeout client".
10951
10952
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010953tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10954 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10956 no | no | yes | yes
10957 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010958 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10959 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010960
10961 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10962
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010963 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010964 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10965 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010966 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10967 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010968
10969 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10970
10971 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10972 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10973 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10974 inserted.
10975
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010976 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010977 - accept :
10978 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10979 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10980 the rules evaluation.
10981
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010982 - close :
10983 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10984 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10985 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10986 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10987 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10988 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010989 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010990 protocols.
10991
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010992 - reject :
10993 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10994 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010995 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010996
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010997 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10998 Sets a variable.
10999
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011000 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11001 Unsets a variable.
11002
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011003 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11004 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11005 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11006 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11007
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011008 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11009 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11010 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11011 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11012
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011013 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11014 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11015 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11016 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11017 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011018
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011019 - "silent-drop" :
11020 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011021 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011022 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11023 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11024 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11025 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11026 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011027 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11028 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011029 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11030 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011031 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011032 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11033 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11034 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11035 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11036
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011037 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11038 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11039
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011040 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11041 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11042 for changing the default action to a reject.
11043
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011044 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11045 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11046 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11047 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011048 period.
11049
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011050 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11051 declared inline.
11052
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011053 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11054 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011055 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011056 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11057 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011058 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011059 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011060 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011061 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11062 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011063 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011064 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11065 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011066
11067 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11068 followed by some converters.
11069
11070 Example:
11071
11072 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11073
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011074 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11075 <var-name>.
11076
11077 Example:
11078
11079 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11080
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011081 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11082 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11083 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11084 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11085 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11086
11087 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11088
11089 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11090
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011091 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11092
11093 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11094
11095
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011096tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11097 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11099 no | yes | yes | no
11100 Arguments :
11101 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11102 below.
11103
11104 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11105
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011106 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011107 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11108 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11109 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11110 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11111 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11112 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11113 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011114 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011115 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11116 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11117 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11118 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11119 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11120 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11121 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11122 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11123 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11124 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11125 instead.
11126
11127 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11128 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11129 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11130 rules which may be inserted.
11131
11132 Several types of actions are supported :
11133 - accept : the request is accepted
11134 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11135 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11136 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011137 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011138 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011139 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011140 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011141 - silent-drop
11142
11143 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11144 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11145 sections for a complete description.
11146
11147 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11148 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11149 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11150
11151 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11152 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11153 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11154 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11155 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11156
11157 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11158 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11159
11160 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11161 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11162 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11163
11164 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11165 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11166 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11167
11168 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11169 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11170 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11171
11172 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11173 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11174 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11175
11176 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11177
11178 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11179
11180
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011181tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11182 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11184 no | no | yes | yes
11185 Arguments :
11186 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11187 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11188 as explained at the top of this document.
11189
11190 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11191
11192
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011193timeout check <timeout>
11194 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11195 established.
11196
11197 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11198 yes | no | yes | yes
11199 Arguments:
11200 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11201 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11202 as explained at the top of this document.
11203
11204 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11205 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011206 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011207 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011208 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11209 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11210 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011211
11212 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11213 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11214
11215 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11216 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011217 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011218
11219 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11220 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11221 forget about it.
11222
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011223 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11224 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011225
11226
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011227timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011228 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11230 yes | yes | yes | no
11231 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011232 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011233 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11234 as explained at the top of this document.
11235
11236 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11237 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11238 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011239 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11240 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11241 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11242 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011243 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11244 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11245 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011246 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011247 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011248 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11249 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011250 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11251 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011252
11253 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11254 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11255 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11256 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011257 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011258 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11259
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011260 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011261
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011262 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011263
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011264
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011265timeout client-fin <timeout>
11266 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11268 yes | yes | yes | no
11269 Arguments :
11270 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11271 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11272 as explained at the top of this document.
11273
11274 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11275 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11276 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11277 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11278 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11279 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11280 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011281 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11282 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11283 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011284
11285 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11286 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11287 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11288
11289 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11290
11291
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011292timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011293 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11295 yes | no | yes | yes
11296 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011297 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011298 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11299 as explained at the top of this document.
11300
11301 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011302 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011303 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011304 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011305 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11306 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011307
11308 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11309 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11310 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11311 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011312 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011313 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11314
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011315 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011316
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011317
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011318timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11319 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11321 yes | yes | yes | yes
11322 Arguments :
11323 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11324 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11325 as explained at the top of this document.
11326
11327 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11328 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11329 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11330 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11331 once the request has started to present itself.
11332
11333 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11334 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11335 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11336 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11337 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11338
11339 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11340 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11341 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11342 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11343
11344 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11345 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011346 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011347 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11348 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011349 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011350
11351 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11352 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11353 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11354 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11355
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011356 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11357 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011358 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11359
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011360 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11361
11362
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011363timeout http-request <timeout>
11364 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011366 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011367 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011368 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011369 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11370 as explained at the top of this document.
11371
11372 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11373 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11374 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11375 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11376 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11377 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11378 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011379 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11380 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11381 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11382 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011383 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011384 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11385 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011386
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011387 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11388 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11389 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11390 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11391 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011392 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011393
11394 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11395 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011396 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011397 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11398 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11399
11400 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011401 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11402 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11403 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011404
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011405 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011406 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011407
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011408
11409timeout queue <timeout>
11410 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11412 yes | no | yes | yes
11413 Arguments :
11414 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11415 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11416 as explained at the top of this document.
11417
11418 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11419 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11420 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11421 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11422 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11423
11424 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11425 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11426 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11427 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11428
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011429 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011430
11431
11432timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011433 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11435 yes | no | yes | yes
11436 Arguments :
11437 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11438 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11439 as explained at the top of this document.
11440
11441 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11442 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11443 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11444 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11445 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11446 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11447 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11448
11449 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11450 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11451 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11452 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11453 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011454 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011455 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011456 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11457 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011458 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11459 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011460
11461 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11462 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11463 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11464 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011465 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011466 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11467
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011468 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011469
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011470
11471timeout server-fin <timeout>
11472 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11474 yes | no | yes | yes
11475 Arguments :
11476 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11477 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11478 as explained at the top of this document.
11479
11480 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11481 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11482 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11483 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11484 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11485 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11486 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11487 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11488 situations, it should not be needed.
11489
11490 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11491 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11492 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11493
11494 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11495
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011496
11497timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011498 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11500 yes | yes | yes | yes
11501 Arguments :
11502 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11503 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11504 as explained at the top of this document.
11505
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011506 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11507 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11508 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011509
11510 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11511 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11512 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11513 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011514 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011515
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011516 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011517
11518
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011519timeout tunnel <timeout>
11520 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11522 yes | no | yes | yes
11523 Arguments :
11524 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11525 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11526 as explained at the top of this document.
11527
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011528 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011529 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11530 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11531 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011532 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11533 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011534 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11535 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11536 specified.
11537
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011538 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11539 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11540 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11541 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11542 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11543 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11544 state.
11545
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011546 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11547 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11548 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11549 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011550 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011551
11552 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11553 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11554 forget about it.
11555
11556 Example :
11557 defaults http
11558 option http-server-close
11559 timeout connect 5s
11560 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011561 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011562 timeout server 30s
11563 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11564
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011565 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011566
11567
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011568transparent (deprecated)
11569 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011571 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011572 Arguments : none
11573
11574 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11575 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11576 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11577 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11578 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11579 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11580 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11581 appropriate server.
11582
11583 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11584
11585 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11586 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11587
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011588 See also: "option transparent"
11589
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011590unique-id-format <string>
11591 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11593 yes | yes | yes | no
11594 Arguments :
11595 <string> is a log-format string.
11596
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011597 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11598 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11599 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11600 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011601
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011602 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11603 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11604 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11605 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11606 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11607 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11608 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11609 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011610
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011611 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11612 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011613
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011614 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011615
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011616 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011617
11618 will generate:
11619
11620 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11621
11622 See also: "unique-id-header"
11623
11624unique-id-header <name>
11625 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11627 yes | yes | yes | no
11628 Arguments :
11629 <name> is the name of the header.
11630
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011631 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11632 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011633
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011634 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011635
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011636 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011637 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11638
11639 will generate:
11640
11641 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11642
11643 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011644
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011645use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011646 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11648 no | yes | yes | no
11649 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011650 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11651 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011652
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011653 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11654 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011655
11656 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11657 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11658 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011659 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011660 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011661 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11662 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011663
11664 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11665 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11666 assign the backend.
11667
11668 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11669 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11670 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11671 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11672 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11673 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11674
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011675 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011676 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011677 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11678 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11679 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11680
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011681 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11682 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11683 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11684 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11685 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11686 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11687 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11688 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11689 cannot be forced from the request.
11690
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011691 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011692 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11693 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11694
11695 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11696 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011697
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011698use-fcgi-app <name>
11699 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11701 no | no | yes | yes
11702 Arguments :
11703 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11704
11705 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011706
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011707use-server <server> if <condition>
11708use-server <server> unless <condition>
11709 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11711 no | no | yes | yes
11712 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011713 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11714 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011715
11716 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11717
11718 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11719 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11720 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11721
11722 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11723 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11724 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11725 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11726 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11727 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11728 matches will assign the server.
11729
11730 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11731 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11732 with the next rules until one matches.
11733
11734 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11735 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11736 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11737 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11738
11739 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11740 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11741 stripped.
11742
11743 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11744 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11745 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11746 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11747
11748 Example :
11749 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11750 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11751 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11752 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11753 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11754 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011755 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011756 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11757 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11758
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011759 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11760 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11761 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11762 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11763 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11764 and we fall back to load balancing.
11765
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011766 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011767
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011768
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100117695. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011770--------------------------
11771
11772The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11773depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11774settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11775written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11776described in this section.
11777
11778
117795.1. Bind options
11780-----------------
11781
11782The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11783as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11784no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11785parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11786while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11787provided immediately after the setting name.
11788
11789The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11790
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011791accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11792 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11793 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11794 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11795 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11796 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11797 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11798 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11799 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11800 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011801 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11802 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11803 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011804
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011805accept-proxy
11806 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011807 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11808 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011809 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11810 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11811 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11812 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011813 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011814 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11815 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011816 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11817 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011818
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011819allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011820 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011821 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011822 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011823 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11824 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011825
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011826alpn <protocols>
11827 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11828 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11829 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011830 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011831 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011832 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11833 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11834 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11835 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11836 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11837 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11838 preference, like below :
11839
11840 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011841
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011842backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011843 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011844 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11845
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011846curves <curves>
11847 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11848 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11849 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11850 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11851 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11852 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11853
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011854ecdhe <named curve>
11855 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011856 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11857 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011858
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011859ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011860 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11861 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11862 client's certificate.
11863
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011864ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11865 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11866 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11867 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11868 error is ignored.
11869
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011870ca-sign-file <cafile>
11871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11872 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11873 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11874 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11875 'generate-certificates' for details.
11876
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011877ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11879 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11880 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11881 'generate-certificates' for details.
11882
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011883ca-verify-file <cafile>
11884 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
11885 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
11886 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
11887 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
11888 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
11889
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011890ciphers <ciphers>
11891 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11892 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011893 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011894 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011895 information and recommendations see e.g.
11896 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11897 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11898 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11899
11900ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11902 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11903 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11904 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011905 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11906 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011907
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011908crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011909 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11910 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11911 to verify client's certificate.
11912
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011913crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011914 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11915 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11916 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11917 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11918 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011919 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11920 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011921
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010011922 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
11923 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
11924
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011925 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11926 are loaded.
11927
11928 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010011929 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
11930 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
11931 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
11932 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
11933 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
11934 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
11935 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011936 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011937
11938 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11939 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11940 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11941 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011942 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11943 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011944
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011945 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011946
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011947 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011948 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011949 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11950 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011951 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11952 clients).
11953
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011954 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11955 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11956 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11957 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11958 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11959 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11960 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11961 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11962 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11963 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11964 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11965 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11966 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11967
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011968 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11969 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11970 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11971 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11972 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11973
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011974 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11975 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11976 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11977 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011978
11979 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11980 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11981 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11982 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11983 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11984 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11985 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11986 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11987 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11988
11989 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11990
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011991 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011992 a cert bundle.
11993
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011994 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011995 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11996 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11997 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11998 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11999 provide multi-cert support.
12000
12001 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12002
12003 Filename | CN | SAN
12004 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12005 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012006 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012007 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12008 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12009
12010 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12011 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12012 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12013 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012014 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12015 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12016 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012017
12018 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12019 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12020
12021 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12022 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12023 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12024
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012025crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012026 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012027 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012028 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012029 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012030
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012031crt-list <file>
12032 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012033 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12034 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012035
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012036 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12037
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012038 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12039 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
12040 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
12041 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012042
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012043 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12044 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12045 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12046 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12047 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12048 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12049 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12050 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012051
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012052 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012053 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012054 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12055 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12056 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012057
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012058 crt-list file example:
12059 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012060 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012061 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012062 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012063
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012064defer-accept
12065 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12066 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12067 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012068 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012069 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12070 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12071 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12072 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12073 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12074 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12075 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12076
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012077expose-fd listeners
12078 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12079 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012080 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12081 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012082 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012083
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012084force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012085 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012086 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012087 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012088 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012089
12090force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012091 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012092 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012093 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012094
12095force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012096 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012097 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012098 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012099
12100force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012101 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012102 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012103 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012104
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012105force-tlsv13
12106 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12107 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012108 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012109
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012110generate-certificates
12111 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12112 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12113 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12114 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12115 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12116 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12117 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12118 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12119 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12120 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12121 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12122
12123 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12124 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012125 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012126 certificate is used many times.
12127
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012128gid <gid>
12129 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12130 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12131 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12132 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12133 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12134
12135group <group>
12136 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12137 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12138 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12139 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12140 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12141
12142id <id>
12143 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12144 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12145 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12146 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12147
12148interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012149 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12150 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12151 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12152 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12153 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12154 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012155 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12156 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12157 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12158 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12159 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12160 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012161
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012162level <level>
12163 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12164 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12165 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012166 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012167 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12168 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12169 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012170 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012171 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012172 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012173 all counters).
12174
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012175severity-output <format>
12176 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12177 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12178 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12179 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12180 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12181 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12182 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12183 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12184 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12185 rfc5424 convention.
12186
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012187maxconn <maxconn>
12188 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12189 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12190 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12191 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12192 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12193 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12194 eat all memory.
12195
12196mode <mode>
12197 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12198 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12199 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12200 UNIX sockets.
12201
12202mss <maxseg>
12203 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12204 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12205 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12206 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12207 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12208 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12209 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12210 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12211 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12212 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12213 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12214
12215name <name>
12216 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12217 page.
12218
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012219namespace <name>
12220 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12221 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12222 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12223 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12224
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012225nice <nice>
12226 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12227 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12228 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12229 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12230 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12231 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12232 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12233 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12234 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12235 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12236 one for an RDP socket.
12237
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012238no-ca-names
12239 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12240 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012241 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012242
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012243no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012245 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012246 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012247 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012248 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12249 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012250
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012251no-tls-tickets
12252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12253 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12254 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012255 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12256 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012257 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12258 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12259 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012260
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012261no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012262 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012263 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012264 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012265 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012266 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12267 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012268
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012269no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012270 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012271 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012272 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012273 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012274 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12275 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012276
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012277no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012279 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012280 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012281 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012282 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12283 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012284
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012285no-tlsv13
12286 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12287 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12288 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12289 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012290 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12291 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012292
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012293npn <protocols>
12294 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12295 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12296 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012297 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012298 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012299 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12300 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12301 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12302 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12303 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012304
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012305prefer-client-ciphers
12306 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12307 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12308 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012309 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12310 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12311 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012312
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012313process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012314 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012315 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012316 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012317 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12318 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12319 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12320 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012321 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012322 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12323 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12324 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12325 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12326 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012327
12328 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12329
12330 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12331 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12332 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12333 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12334 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12335 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12336 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12337 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012338
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012339proto <name>
12340 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12341 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12342 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12343 in haproxy -vv.
12344 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12345 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012346 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012347 h2" on the bind line.
12348
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012349ssl
12350 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012351 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012352 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12353 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012354 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12355 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012356
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012357ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12358 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
12359 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12360 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12361
12362ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12363 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
12364 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12365 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12366
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012367strict-sni
12368 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12369 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12370 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12371 See the "crt" option for more information.
12372
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012373tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012374 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012375 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12376 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012377 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012378 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12379 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12380 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12381 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12382 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12383 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12384 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12385
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012386tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012387 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012388 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12389 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12390 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12391 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12392 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12393 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12394 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012395 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12396 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12397 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012398
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012399tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12400 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012401 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12402 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12403 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12404 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12405 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12406 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12407 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12408 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12409 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12410 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012411 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12412 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12413
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012414transparent
12415 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12416 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12417 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12418 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12419 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12420 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12421 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12422 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12423 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12424 so check for support with your vendor.
12425
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012426v4v6
12427 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12428 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12429 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12430 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012431 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012432
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012433v6only
12434 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12435 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12436 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012437 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12438 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012439
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012440uid <uid>
12441 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12442 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12443 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12444 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12445 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12446
12447user <user>
12448 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12449 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12450 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12451 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12452 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12453
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012454verify [none|optional|required]
12455 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12456 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12457 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12458 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12459 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012460 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12461 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12462 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12463 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012464
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200124655.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012466------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012467
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012468The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12469which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12470arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12471settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12472after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12473Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12474address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012476 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012477 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012478
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012479Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12480keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012482The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012483
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012484addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012485 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012486 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12487 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12488 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12489 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12490 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012491
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012492agent-check
12493 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012494 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012495 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12496 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12497 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012498
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012499 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012500 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012501 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12502 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12503 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012504
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012505 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12506 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12507 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12508 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12509 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012510
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012511 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012512 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012513
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012514 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12515 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12516 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012517
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012518 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12519 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12520 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012521
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012522 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12523 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12524 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12525 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12526 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012527 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012528 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012529
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012530 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12531 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012532
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012533 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12534 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12535 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12536 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12537 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12538 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12539 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12540 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12541 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012542
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012543 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12544 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012545 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12546 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12547 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012548 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012549
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012550 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012551 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012552
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012553agent-send <string>
12554 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12555 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12556 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12557 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12558 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12559
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012560agent-inter <delay>
12561 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12562 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12563
12564 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12565 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12566 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12567 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12568 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12569 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12570 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12571 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12572 of backends use the same servers.
12573
12574 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12575
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012576agent-addr <addr>
12577 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12578
12579 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12580 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12581 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12582 hostname, it will be resolved.
12583
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012584agent-port <port>
12585 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12586
12587 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12588
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012589allow-0rtt
12590 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012591 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12592 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012593
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012594alpn <protocols>
12595 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12596 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12597 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012598 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012599 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12600 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12601 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12602 now obsolete NPN extension.
12603 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12604 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12605
12606 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012608backup
12609 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12610 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12611 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12612 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012613 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12614 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012615
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012616ca-file <cafile>
12617 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12618 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12619 server's certificate.
12620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012621check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012622 This option enables health checks on a server:
12623 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
12624 considered available.
12625 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
12626 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
12627 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
12628 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
12629 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
12630 set.
12631 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
12632 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
12633 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
12634 exchanges succeed.
12635
12636 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
12637 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
12638 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
12639 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
12640 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050012641 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012642 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
12643
12644 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
12645 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
12646
12647 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
12648 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
12649
12650 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
12651 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
12652 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
12653 available.
12654
12655 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
12656 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
12657 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
12658
12659 Example:
12660 # simple tcp check
12661 backend foo
12662 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
12663 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
12664 backend foo
12665 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
12666 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
12667 backend foo
12668 option tcp-check
12669 tcp-check connect
12670 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012671
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012672check-send-proxy
12673 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12674 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12675 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12676 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12677 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12678 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12679 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12680
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012681check-alpn <protocols>
12682 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12683 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12684 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12685
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012686check-proto <name>
12687 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
12688 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
12689 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
12690 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
12691 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12692 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
12693 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
12694
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012695check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012696 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012697 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12698 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012699
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012700check-ssl
12701 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12702 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12703 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12704 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012705 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012706 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12707 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012708 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012709 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12710 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012711
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012712check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012713 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012714 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12715 for normal traffic.
12716
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012717ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012718 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12719 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12720 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012721 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12722 information and recommendations see e.g.
12723 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12724 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12725 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012726
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012727ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12728 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12729 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12730 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12731 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012732 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12733 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12734 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012736cookie <value>
12737 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12738 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12739 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12740 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12741 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12742 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12743 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12744
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012745crl-file <crlfile>
12746 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12747 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12748 to verify server's certificate.
12749
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012750crt <cert>
12751 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12752 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12753 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12754 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12755 certificate request.
12756
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012757disabled
12758 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12759 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12760 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12761 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12762 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012763 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012764
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012765enabled
12766 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12767 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12768 default value.
12769 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12770 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012772error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012773 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12774 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12775 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012776
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012777 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012778
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012779fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012780 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12781 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12782 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12783
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012784force-sslv3
12785 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12786 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012787 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012788 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012789
12790force-tlsv10
12791 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012792 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012793 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012794
12795force-tlsv11
12796 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012797 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012798 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012799
12800force-tlsv12
12801 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012802 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012803 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012804
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012805force-tlsv13
12806 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12807 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012808 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012810id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012811 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12812 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12813 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012814
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012815init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12816 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12817 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012818 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012819 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12820 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12821 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12822 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12823 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12824 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12825 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12826 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12827 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012828 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012829 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12830 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12831 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12832 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12833 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12834 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012835 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012836
12837 Example:
12838 defaults
12839 # never fail on address resolution
12840 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012842inter <delay>
12843fastinter <delay>
12844downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012845 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12846 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12847 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12848 between checks depending on the server state :
12849
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012850 Server state | Interval used
12851 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12852 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12853 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12854 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12855 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12856 or yet unchecked. |
12857 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12858 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12859 | "inter" otherwise.
12860 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012862 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12863 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12864 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12865 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012866 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12867 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12868 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12869 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12870 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012871
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012872maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012873 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12874 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012875 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12876 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012877 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12878 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12879 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12880 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12881
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012882 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12883 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12884 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12885 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12886 than 50 concurrent requests.
12887
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012888maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012889 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12890 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12891 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12892 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12893 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12894 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12895 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12896
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012897max-reuse <count>
12898 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12899 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12900 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12901 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12902 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12903 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12904 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12905 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12906
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012907minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012908 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12909 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12910 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12911 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12912 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12913 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012914 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012915 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012916
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012917namespace <name>
12918 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12919 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12920 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12921 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12922
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012923no-agent-check
12924 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12925 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12926 default value.
12927 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12928 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12929
12930no-backup
12931 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12932 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12933 default value.
12934 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12935 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12936
12937no-check
12938 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12939 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12940 default value.
12941 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12942 "default-server" "check" setting.
12943
12944no-check-ssl
12945 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12946 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12947 default value.
12948 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12949 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12950
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012951no-send-proxy
12952 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12953 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12954 default value.
12955 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12956 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12957
12958no-send-proxy-v2
12959 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12960 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12961 default value.
12962 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12963 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12964
12965no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12966 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12967 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12968 default value.
12969 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12970 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12971
12972no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12973 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12974 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12975 default value.
12976 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12977 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12978
12979no-ssl
12980 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12981 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12982 default value.
12983 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12984 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12985
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012986no-ssl-reuse
12987 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12988 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12989 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12990 and for paranoid users.
12991
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012992no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012993 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12994 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012995 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012996
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012997 Supported in default-server: No
12998
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012999no-tls-tickets
13000 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13001 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13002 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013003 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13004 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013005 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13006 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13007 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013008 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013009
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013010no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013011 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013012 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13013 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013014 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13015 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013016 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013017
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013018 Supported in default-server: No
13019
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013020no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013021 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013022 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13023 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013024 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13025 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013026 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013027
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013028 Supported in default-server: No
13029
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013030no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013031 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013032 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13033 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013034 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13035 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013036 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013037
13038 Supported in default-server: No
13039
13040no-tlsv13
13041 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13042 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13043 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13044 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13045 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013046 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013047
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013048 Supported in default-server: No
13049
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013050no-verifyhost
13051 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13052 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13053 default value.
13054 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13055 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013056
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013057no-tfo
13058 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13059 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13060 default value.
13061 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13062 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13063
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013064non-stick
13065 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13066 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13067 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13068
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013069npn <protocols>
13070 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13071 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13072 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013073 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013074 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13075 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13076 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13077
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013078observe <mode>
13079 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13080 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13081 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13082 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13083 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13084 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013085 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013086
13087 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13088
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013089on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013090 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13091 Currently, four modes are available:
13092 - fastinter: force fastinter
13093 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13094 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13095 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13096 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13097
13098 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13099
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013100on-marked-down <action>
13101 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13102 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013103 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13104 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13105 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13106 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13107 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13108 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13109 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13110 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013111
13112 Actions are disabled by default
13113
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013114on-marked-up <action>
13115 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13116 Currently one action is available:
13117 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13118 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13119 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13120 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013121 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13122 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013123 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13124 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13125
13126 Actions are disabled by default
13127
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013128pool-max-conn <max>
13129 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13130 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13131 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13132 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13133 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13134 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13135
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013136pool-purge-delay <delay>
13137 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013138 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013139 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013140
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013141port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013142 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13143 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13144 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13145 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13146 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13147 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13148
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013149proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013150 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13151 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13152 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13153 reported in haproxy -vv.
13154 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
13155 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013157redir <prefix>
13158 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13159 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13160 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13161 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13162 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13163 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13164 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13165 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013166 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013167 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013168 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13169 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13170 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13171 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13172
13173 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013175rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013176 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13177 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13178 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13179
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013180resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13181 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13182 server.
13183
13184 Available options:
13185
13186 * allow-dup-ip
13187 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13188 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13189 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13190 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13191 For such case, simply enable this option.
13192 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13193
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013194 * ignore-weight
13195 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13196 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13197 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13198
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013199 * prevent-dup-ip
13200 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13201 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13202 same fqdn.
13203 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13204
13205 Example:
13206 backend b_myapp
13207 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13208 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13209 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13210
13211 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13212 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13213 it
13214 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13215 different address
13216
13217 Default value: not set
13218
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013219resolve-prefer <family>
13220 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13221 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13222 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13223 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13224
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013225 Default value: ipv6
13226
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013227 Example:
13228
13229 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013230
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013231resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013232 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013233 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013234 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013235 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13236 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013237 configured network, another address is selected.
13238
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013239 Example:
13240
13241 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013242
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013243resolvers <id>
13244 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13245 hostname.
13246
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013247 Example:
13248
13249 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013250
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013251 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013252
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013253send-proxy
13254 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13255 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13256 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13257 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013258 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13259 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13260 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13261 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13262 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13263 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13264 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13265 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13266 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13267 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013268 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13269 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013270
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013271send-proxy-v2
13272 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13273 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13274 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13275 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013276 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13277 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13278 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13279 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013280
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013281proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013282 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13283 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13284
13285 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13286 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13287 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13288 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13289 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13290 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13291 connection is supported).
13292 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13293 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13294 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13295 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13296 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13297 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13298 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013299
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013300send-proxy-v2-ssl
13301 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13302 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13303 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13304 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13305 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13306 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13307 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013308 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13309 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013310
13311send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13312 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13313 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13314 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13315 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13316 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13317 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13318 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13319 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013320 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13321 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013322
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013323slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013324 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13325 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13326 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13327 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13328 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13329 parameters :
13330
13331 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13332 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13333
13334 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13335 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13336 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13337 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13338
13339 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13340 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13341 seen as failed.
13342
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013343sni <expression>
13344 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13345 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13346 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13347 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013348 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13349 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013350 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013351 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13352 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013353
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013354source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013355source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013356source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013357 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13358 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13359 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13360 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13361
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013362 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13363 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13364 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13365 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13366 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13367 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13368 server.
13369
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013370 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13371 specifying the source address without port(s).
13372
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013373ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013374 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13375 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13376 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13377 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13378 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13379 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013380 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13381 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013382
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013383ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13384 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13385 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13386 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13387
13388ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13389 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13390 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13391 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13392
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013393ssl-reuse
13394 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13395 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13396 default value.
13397 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13398 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13399
13400stick
13401 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13402 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13403 default value.
13404 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13405 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013406
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013407socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013408 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013409 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13410 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13411
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013412tcp-ut <delay>
13413 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13414 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13415 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013416 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013417 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13418 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13419 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13420 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13421 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13422 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13423 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13424 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13425 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13426
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013427tfo
13428 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13429 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13430 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13431 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13432 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013433 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013434
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013435track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013436 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13437 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13438 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13439 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013440 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13441
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013442tls-tickets
13443 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13444 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13445 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013446 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13447 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13448 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013449 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013450 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013451
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013452verify [none|required]
13453 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013454 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013455 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13456 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013457 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013458 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13459 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13460 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13461 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13462 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13463 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13464 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13465 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013466
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013467verifyhost <hostname>
13468 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013469 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13470 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13471 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13472 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13473 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13474 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13475 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13476 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013477
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013478weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013479 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13480 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13481 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013482 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13483 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13484 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13485 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13486 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13487 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013488
13489
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200134905.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13491-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013492
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013493HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13494using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13495configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013496This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13497can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13498workload.
13499This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13500resolution at run time.
13501Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13502carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13503
13504
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200135055.3.1. Global overview
13506----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013507
13508As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13509different steps of the process life:
13510
13511 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13512 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13513 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13514
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013515 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13516 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013517
13518A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13519 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13520 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13521 resolution to know this new IP.
13522
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013523When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013524HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013525SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13526from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13527will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13528will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013529
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013530A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013531 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013532 first valid response.
13533
13534 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13535 servers return an error.
13536
13537
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200135385.3.2. The resolvers section
13539----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013540
13541This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013542HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13543contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013544
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013545When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13546uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13547is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13548answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13549
13550When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013551used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013552
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013553 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13554 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13555 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013556
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013557 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13558 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013559
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013560 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13561 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13562 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013563
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013564For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13565following scenarios are possible:
13566
13567 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13568 ignored
13569
13570 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13571 applied
13572
13573 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13574 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13575
13576 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13577 retries the query with a new type
13578
13579 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13580 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013581
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013582As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13583a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013584<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013585
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013586
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013587resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013588 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013589
13590A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13591
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013592accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013593 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013594 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013595 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13596 by RFC 6891)
13597
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013598 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13599
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013600nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13601 DNS server description:
13602 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13603 <ip> : IP address of the server
13604 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13605
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013606parse-resolv-conf
13607 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13608 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13609 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13610
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013611hold <status> <period>
13612 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13613 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013614 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013615 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013616 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13617 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13618 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13619
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013620 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013621
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013622resolve_retries <nb>
13623 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13624 giving up.
13625 Default value: 3
13626
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013627 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13628 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13629 type.
13630
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013631timeout <event> <time>
13632 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13633 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13634 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013635 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13636 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013637 Default value: 1s
13638 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013639 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013640 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013641 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13642 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13643
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013644 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013645
13646 resolvers mydns
13647 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13648 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013649 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013650 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013651 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013652 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013653 hold other 30s
13654 hold refused 30s
13655 hold nx 30s
13656 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013657 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013658 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013659
13660
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200136616. Cache
13662---------
13663
13664HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13665(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13666RAM.
13667
13668The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13669this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13670
13671If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13672independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13673when we try to allocate a new one.
13674
13675The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13676
13677It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13678"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13679for more details.
13680
13681When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13682replaced by "<CACHE>".
13683
13684
136856.1. Limitation
13686----------------
13687
13688The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13689
13690- If the response is not a 200
13691- If the response contains a Vary header
13692- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13693- If the response is not cacheable
13694
13695- If the request is not a GET
13696- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13697- If the request contains an Authorization header
13698
13699
137006.2. Setup
13701-----------
13702
13703To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13704the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13705
13706
137076.2.1. Cache section
13708---------------------
13709
13710cache <name>
13711 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13712 size of cache is mandatory.
13713
13714total-max-size <megabytes>
13715 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13716 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13717
13718max-object-size <bytes>
13719 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13720 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13721 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13722
13723max-age <seconds>
13724 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13725 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13726 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13727 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13728 default.
13729
13730
137316.2.2. Proxy section
13732---------------------
13733
13734http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13735 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13736 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13737 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13738 after this one.
13739
13740http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13741 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13742 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13743 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13744 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13745
13746
13747Example:
13748
13749 backend bck1
13750 mode http
13751
13752 http-request cache-use foobar
13753 http-response cache-store foobar
13754 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13755
13756 cache foobar
13757 total-max-size 4
13758 max-age 240
13759
13760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200137617. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13762----------------------------------
13763
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013764HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013765client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13766The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13767these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13768but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13769data called patterns.
13770
13771
137727.1. ACL basics
13773---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013774
13775The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13776content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13777from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13778simple :
13779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013780 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013781 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013782 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13783 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013785The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13786adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013787
13788In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013790 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013791
13792This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13793Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13794and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013795an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13796conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13797as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13798are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013799
13800ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13801'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13802which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13803
13804There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13805performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013807The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13808specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13809this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013810methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13811ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013812
13813Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13814 - boolean
13815 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13816 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13817 - string
13818 - data block
13819
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013820Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13821converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13822would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13823The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13824which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13825
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013826Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13827keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13828fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13829which are summarized in the table below :
13830
13831 +---------------------+-----------------+
13832 | Sample or converter | Default |
13833 | output type | matching method |
13834 +---------------------+-----------------+
13835 | boolean | bool |
13836 +---------------------+-----------------+
13837 | integer | int |
13838 +---------------------+-----------------+
13839 | ip | ip |
13840 +---------------------+-----------------+
13841 | string | str |
13842 +---------------------+-----------------+
13843 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13844 +---------------------+-----------------+
13845
13846Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13847matching method, see below.
13848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013849The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13850 - boolean
13851 - integer or integer range
13852 - IP address / network
13853 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13854 - regular expression
13855 - hex block
13856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013857The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13858
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013859 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13860 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013861 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013862 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013863 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013864 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013865 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013867The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13868read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13869if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13870lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13871will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13872beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13873a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13874lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13875exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13876
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013877The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13878parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13879ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13880a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13881check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13882
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013883The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13884socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13885file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013887Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13888loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13889
13890 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13891
13892In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13893the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13894case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13895as well.
13896
13897The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13898sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13899do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13900methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13901is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013902obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013903followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13904default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13905that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13906string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13907
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013908The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13909By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13910string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13911resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13912server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013913waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013914flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13915function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013917There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13918sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13919be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013920
13921 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13922 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013923 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13924 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13925 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13926 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013927
13928 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13929 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013930 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013931
13932 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013933 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013934
13935 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013936 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013937
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013938 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013939 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13940
13941 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13942 binary or string samples.
13943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013944 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13945 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013947 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13948 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13949 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013951 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13952 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013954 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13955 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013957 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13958 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013960 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13961 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013962 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013964 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13965 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13966 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013967
13968For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13969request, it is possible to do :
13970
13971 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13972
13973In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13974buffer, one would use the following acl :
13975
13976 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13977
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013978On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13979possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13980
13981 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013983All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13984criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13985method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13986to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13987criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13988the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013990If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013991the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13992For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013994 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13995 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13996 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13997 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013998
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013999
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014000The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14001types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14002combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14003brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14004default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014006 +-------------------------------------------------+
14007 | Input sample type |
14008 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014009 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014010 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14011 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14012 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014013 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014014 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014015 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014016 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014017 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014018 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014019 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014020 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014021 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014022 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014023 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014024 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014025 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014026 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014027 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014028 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014029 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014030 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014031 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014032 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014033 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014034 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14035 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14036 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014037
14038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140397.1.1. Matching booleans
14040------------------------
14041
14042In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14043Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14044When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14045that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14046
14047Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14048return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14049"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14050
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140527.1.2. Matching integers
14053------------------------
14054
14055Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14056enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14057to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14058
14059Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14060matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14061lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014062
14063For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14064unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14065representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14066
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014067As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14068two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14069instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14070ranges and operators.
14071
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014072For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014073operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14074Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14075of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014076
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014077Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014078
14079 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14080 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14081 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14082 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14083 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14084
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014085For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014086
14087 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14088
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014089This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14090
14091 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14092
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140947.1.3. Matching strings
14095-----------------------
14096
14097String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14098different forms :
14099
14100 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014101 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014102
14103 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014104 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014105
14106 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14107 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14108
14109 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14110 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14111
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014112 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014113 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14114 matches.
14115
14116 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14117 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14118 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014119
14120String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14121exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14122characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14123string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14124to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014125before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014126
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014127Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14128(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14129Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14130
14131Example:
14132 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14133 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14134
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200141367.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14137---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014138
14139Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14140they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14141possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14142passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14143the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014144the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14145match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014146
14147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200141487.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14149-------------------------------------
14150
14151It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14152not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14153a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14154to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14155digits may be used upper or lower case.
14156
14157Example :
14158 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14159 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14160
14161
141627.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14163---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014164
14165IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14166netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14167within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014168host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014169difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14170at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14171does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14172parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014173
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014174The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14175abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14176
14177 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14178 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14179 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14180 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14181 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14182 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14183 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14184 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14185
14186Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14187192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14188
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014189IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14190Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14191trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14192IPv6 patterns.
14193
14194HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14195following situations :
14196 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14197 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14198 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14199 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14200 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14201 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14202 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14203 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14204 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14205 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014207
142087.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14209----------------------------------
14210
14211Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14212combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14213
14214 - AND (implicit)
14215 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14216 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014218A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014220 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014222Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14223indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014225For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14226"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14227requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14228is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14229
14230 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014231 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14232 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14233 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014234
14235To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14236and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14237
14238 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14239 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14240 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14241 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14242
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014243 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014244 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14245 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14246 use_backend www if host_www
14247
14248It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14249expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14250be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14251the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14252
14253 The following rule :
14254
14255 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014256 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014257
14258 Can also be written that way :
14259
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014260 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014261
14262It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14263to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14264simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14265sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14266good use is the following :
14267
14268 With named ACLs :
14269
14270 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14271 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14272 monitor fail if site_dead
14273
14274 With anonymous ACLs :
14275
14276 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14277
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014278See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14279keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014280
14281
142827.3. Fetching samples
14283---------------------
14284
14285Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14286against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14287sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14288ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14289of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14290available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14291
14292This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14293Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14294compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14295deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14296
14297The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14298matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14299method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14300indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14301
14302As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14303when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14304mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14305the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14306ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14307
14308Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14309multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14310when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014311incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14312are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014313is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14314all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14315
14316Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14317 - name
14318 - name(arg1)
14319 - name(arg1,arg2)
14320
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014321
143227.3.1. Converters
14323-----------------
14324
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014325Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14326of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14327is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14328was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014329has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014330unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14331
14332These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14333sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14334the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014335support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014336
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014337A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14338support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14339supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14340(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14341bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014343The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014344
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001434551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14346 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14347 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14348 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14349 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14350 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14351
14352 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014353 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14354 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014355 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14356 frontend http-in
14357 bind *:8081
14358 default_backend servers
14359 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14360 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14361
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014362add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014363 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014364 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014365 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14366 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014367 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014368 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14369 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14370 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14371 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014372 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014373 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014374
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014375aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14376 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14377 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14378 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14379 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14380 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14381 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14382
14383 Example:
14384 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14385 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14386
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014387and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014388 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014389 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014390 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14391 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014392 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014393 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14394 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14395 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14396 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014397 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014398 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014399
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014400b64dec
14401 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14402 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14403
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014404base64
14405 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014406 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014407 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14408
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014409bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014410 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014411 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014412 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014413 presence of a flag).
14414
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014415bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14416 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14417 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014418 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014419
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014420concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14421 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14422 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14423 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14424 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14425 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14426 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14427 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14428 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14429 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14430 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014431 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14432 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14433 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14434 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014435
14436 Example:
14437 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14438 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14439 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014440 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014441 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14442
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014443cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014444 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14445 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014446
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014447crc32([<avalanche>])
14448 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14449 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14450 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14451 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14452 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14453 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14454 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14455 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14456 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14457 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014458 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14459
14460crc32c([<avalanche>])
14461 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14462 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14463 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14464 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14465 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14466 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14467 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14468 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014469
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014470cut_crlf
14471 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14472 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14473 updated.
14474
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014475da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014476 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14477 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14478 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14479 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014480 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014481 configuration language.
14482
14483 Example:
14484 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014485 bind *:8881
14486 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014487 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014488
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014489debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14490 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14491 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14492 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14493 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14494 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14495 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14496 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14497 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14498 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14499 printable sample types.
14500
14501 Example:
14502 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014503
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014504digest(<algorithm>)
14505 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
14506 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
14507
14508 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14509 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14510
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014511div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014512 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14513 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014514 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014515 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14516 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014517 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014518 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14519 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14520 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14521 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014522 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014523 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014524
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014525djb2([<avalanche>])
14526 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14527 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14528 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14529 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14530 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14531 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14532 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014533 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14534 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014535
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014536even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014537 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014538 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14539
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014540field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14541 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14542 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14543 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14544 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14545 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14546 fields.
14547
14548 Example :
14549 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14550 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14551 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14552 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14553 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014554
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014555hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014556 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014557 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014558 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014559 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014560
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014561hex2i
14562 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014563 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014564
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014565htonl
14566 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14567 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14568 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14569 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14570
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014571hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
14572 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
14573 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
14574 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
14575 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
14576
14577 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14578 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14579
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014580http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014581 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14582 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014583 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14584 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14585 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14586 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14587 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14588 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14589 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14590 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014591
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014592in_table(<table>)
14593 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14594 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14595 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014596 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014597 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14598
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014599ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14600 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014601 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014602 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14603 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14604 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14605 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14606 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014607
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014608json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014609 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014610 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014611 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014612 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14613 of errors:
14614 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14615 bytes, ...)
14616 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14617 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14618
14619 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14620 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14621 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14622 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14623 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14624 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014625 - "ascii" : never fails;
14626 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14627 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014628 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014629 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014630 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14631 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14632
14633 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014634 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014635
14636 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014637 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014638 capture request header user-agent len 150
14639 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014640
14641 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14642 GET / HTTP/1.0
14643 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14644
14645 Output log:
14646 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14647
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014648language(<value>[,<default>])
14649 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14650 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14651 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14652 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14653 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14654 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14655 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14656 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14657 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014658 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014659 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14660 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014661
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014662 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014663
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014664 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14665 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014666
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014667 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14668 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14669 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14670 use_backend spanish if es
14671 use_backend french if fr
14672 use_backend english if en
14673 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014674
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014675length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014676 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14677 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14678 type. The result is of type integer.
14679
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014680lower
14681 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14682 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14683 type. The result is of type string.
14684
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014685ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14686 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14687 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14688 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14689 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14690 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14691 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14692
14693 Example :
14694
14695 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014696 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014697 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14698
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014699ltrim(<chars>)
14700 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14701 representation of the input sample.
14702
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014703map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14704map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14705map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14706 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14707 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14708 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14709 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14710 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14711 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14712 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14713 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014714
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014715 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14716 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14717 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014718
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014719 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014720 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014721
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014722 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14723 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14724 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14725 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014726 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14727 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014728 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14729 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14730 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14731 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14732 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14733 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14734 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14735 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014736 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14737 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14738 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014739 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14740 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14741 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14742 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14743 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014744
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014745 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14746 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14747 the corresponding match text.
14748
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014749 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14750 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14751 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14752 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14753 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014754
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014755 Example :
14756
14757 # this is a comment and is ignored
14758 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14759 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14760 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14761 | | | `---------- value
14762 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14763 | `---------------------------- key
14764 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14765
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014766mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014767 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14768 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014769 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014770 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014771 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014772 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14773 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14774 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14775 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014776 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014777 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014778
14779mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014780 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014781 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14782 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014783 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014784 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014785 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014786 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14787 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14788 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14789 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014790 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014791 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014792
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014793nbsrv
14794 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14795 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14796 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14797 map lookup.
14798
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014799neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014800 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14801 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14802 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14803 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014804
14805not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014806 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014807 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014808 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014809 absence of a flag).
14810
14811odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014812 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014813 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14814
14815or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014816 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014817 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014818 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14819 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014820 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014821 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14822 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14823 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14824 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014825 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014826 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014827
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014828protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14829 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14830 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14831 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14832 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14833 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14834 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14835 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14836 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14837 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14838 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14839 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14840
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014841regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014842 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14843 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14844 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14845 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14846 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14847 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14848 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14849 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14850 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014851 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14852 of characters with other ones.
14853
14854 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14855 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14856 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14857 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14858 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14859 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014860
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014861 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014862
14863 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14864 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14865 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014866 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014867
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014868 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14869 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14870
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014871 # capture groups and backreferences
14872 # both lines do the same.
14873 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14874 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14875
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014876capture-req(<id>)
14877 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14878 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14879
14880 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014881 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14882 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014883
14884capture-res(<id>)
14885 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14886 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14887
14888 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014889 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14890 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014891
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020014892rtrim(<chars>)
14893 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
14894 of the input sample.
14895
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014896sdbm([<avalanche>])
14897 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14898 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14899 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14900 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14901 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14902 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14903 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014904 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14905 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014906
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014907set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014908 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14909 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14910 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014911 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014912 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14913 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014914 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014915 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14916 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014917 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014918 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014919
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014920sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014921 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014922 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14923
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014924sha2([<bits>])
14925 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14926 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14927
14928 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14929 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14930
14931 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14932 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14933
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014934srv_queue
14935 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14936 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14937 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14938 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14939 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14940
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014941strcmp(<var>)
14942 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14943 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14944 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14945 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14946 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14947 shorter).
14948
14949 Example :
14950
14951 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14952 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14953 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14954
14955
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014956sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014957 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14958 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014959 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014960 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14961 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014962 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014963 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14964 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014965 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014966 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14967 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014968 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014969 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014970
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014971table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14972 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14973 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14974 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14975 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14976 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14977 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14978
14979
14980table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14981 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14982 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14983 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14984 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14985 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14986 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14987
14988table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14989 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14990 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014991 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014992 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14993 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14994
14995table_conn_cur(<table>)
14996 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14997 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14998 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14999 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15000 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15001
15002table_conn_rate(<table>)
15003 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15004 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15005 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15006 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15007 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15008
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015009table_gpt0(<table>)
15010 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15011 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15012 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15013 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15014 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15015
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015016table_gpc0(<table>)
15017 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15018 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15019 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15020 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15021 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15022
15023table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15024 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15025 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15026 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15027 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15028 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15029 sample fetch keyword.
15030
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015031table_gpc1(<table>)
15032 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15033 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15034 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15035 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15036 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15037
15038table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15039 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15040 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15041 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15042 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15043 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15044 sample fetch keyword.
15045
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015046table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15047 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15048 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015049 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015050 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15051 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15052
15053table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15054 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15055 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15056 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15057 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15058 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15059 keyword.
15060
15061table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15062 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15063 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015064 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015065 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15066 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15067
15068table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15069 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15070 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15071 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15072 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15073 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15074 keyword.
15075
15076table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15077 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15078 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015079 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015080 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15081 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15082 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15083 keyword.
15084
15085table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15086 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15087 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015088 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015089 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15090 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15091 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15092 keyword.
15093
15094table_server_id(<table>)
15095 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15096 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15097 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15098 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15099 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15100 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15101
15102table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15103 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15104 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015105 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015106 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15107 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15108 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15109 keyword.
15110
15111table_sess_rate(<table>)
15112 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15113 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15114 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15115 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15116 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15117 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15118 keyword.
15119
15120table_trackers(<table>)
15121 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15122 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15123 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15124 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15125 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15126 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15127 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15128 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15129 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15130 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15131
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015132upper
15133 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15134 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15135 type. The result is of type string.
15136
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015137url_dec([<in_form>])
15138 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15139 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15140 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15141 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15142 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15143 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015144
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015145ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015146 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015147 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15148 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15149 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015150 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15151 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15152 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15153 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015154 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015155 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15156 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015157
15158 Example:
15159 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15160 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15161
15162 message Point {
15163 int32 latitude = 1;
15164 int32 longitude = 2;
15165 }
15166
15167 message PPoint {
15168 Point point = 59;
15169 }
15170
15171 message Rectangle {
15172 // One corner of the rectangle.
15173 PPoint lo = 48;
15174 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15175 PPoint hi = 49;
15176 }
15177
15178 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15179 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15180 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
15181
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015182 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15183 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015184 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015185 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15186
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015187 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015188
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015189 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015190
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015191 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015192 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15193 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
15194
15195 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15196 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15197 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15198
15199 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15200 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15201 interpret the previous binary sample.
15202
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015203
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015204unset-var(<var name>)
15205 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15206 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15207 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15208 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15209 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15210 response),
15211 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15212 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15213 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15214 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15215
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015216utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15217 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15218 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15219 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15220 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15221 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15222 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15223
15224 Example :
15225
15226 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015227 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015228 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15229
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015230word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15231 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15232 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15233 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015234 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015235 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15236 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15237
15238 Example :
15239 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15240 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15241 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15242 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15243 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015244 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015245
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015246wt6([<avalanche>])
15247 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15248 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15249 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15250 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15251 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15252 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15253 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015254 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15255 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015256
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015257xor(<value>)
15258 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015259 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015260 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015261 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015262 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015263 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15264 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015265 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015266 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15267 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015268 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015269 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015270
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015271xxh32([<seed>])
15272 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15273 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15274 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15275 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15276 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15277 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15278 as cryptographically secure.
15279
15280xxh64([<seed>])
15281 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15282 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15283 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15284 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15285 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15286 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15287 as cryptographically secure.
15288
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015289
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152907.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015291--------------------------------------------
15292
15293A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15294not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15295"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15296The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15297
15298always_false : boolean
15299 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15300 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15301
15302always_true : boolean
15303 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15304 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15305
15306avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015307 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015308 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15309 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15310 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15311 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15312 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15313 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15314 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15315 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15316 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15317 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15318 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15319 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15320 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015322be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015323 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15324 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15325 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15326 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015327 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15328
15329be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15330 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15331 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15332 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15333 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15334 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015335 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15336 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015337
15338 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15339 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15340 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015342be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15343 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15344 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15345 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015346 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015347 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15348 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015349
15350 Example :
15351 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15352 backend dynamic
15353 mode http
15354 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15355 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015356
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015357bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015358 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15359 of the string.
15360
15361bool(<bool>) : bool
15362 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15363 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015365connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15366 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015367 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015368 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15369 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015370
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015371 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015372 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015373 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15374
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015375 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15376 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015377
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015378 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015379 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015380 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015381 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015382 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015383 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015384 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015385
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015386 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15387 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015388 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015389 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015390
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015391cpu_calls : integer
15392 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15393 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15394 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15395 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15396 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15397 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15398
15399cpu_ns_avg : integer
15400 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15401 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15402 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15403 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15404 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15405 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15406 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15407 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15408 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15409 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15410 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15411
15412cpu_ns_tot : integer
15413 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15414 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15415 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15416 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15417 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15418 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15419 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15420 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15421 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15422 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15423 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15424 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15425 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15426
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015427date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015428 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015429
15430 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15431 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15432 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015433 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15434
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015435 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15436 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15437 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15438 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15439 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15440
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015441 Example :
15442
15443 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15444 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015445
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015446 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15447 # millisecond granularity
15448 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15449
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015450date_us : integer
15451 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15452 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15453 from the same timeval structure.
15454
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015455distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15456 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15457 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15458 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15459 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15460 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15461 list of supported tokens.
15462
15463distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15464 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15465 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15466 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15467 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15468 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15469 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15470 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15471 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15472 supported tokens.
15473
15474 Example :
15475 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15476 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15477 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15478 # send large files to the big farm
15479 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15480
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015481env(<name>) : string
15482 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15483 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15484 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15485 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15486 certain way.
15487
15488 Examples :
15489 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15490 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15491
15492 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15493 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015495fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15496 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015497 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15498 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015499 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15500 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015501 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015502 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15503 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015504
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015505fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15506 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15507 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15508 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015510fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15511 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15512 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15513 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15514 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15515 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15516 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15517 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15518 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015519
15520 Example :
15521 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15522 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15523 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15524 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15525 frontend mail
15526 bind :25
15527 mode tcp
15528 maxconn 100
15529 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15530 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15531 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15532 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015533
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015534hostname : string
15535 Returns the system hostname.
15536
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015537int(<integer>) : signed integer
15538 Returns a signed integer.
15539
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015540ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15541 Returns an ipv4.
15542
15543ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15544 Returns an ipv6.
15545
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015546lat_ns_avg : integer
15547 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15548 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15549 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15550 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15551 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15552 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15553 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15554 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15555 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15556 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15557 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15558 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15559 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15560 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15561
15562lat_ns_tot : integer
15563 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15564 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15565 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15566 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15567 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15568 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15569 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15570 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15571 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15572 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15573 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15574 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15575 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15576 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15577 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15578 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15579 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15580 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15581 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15582
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015583meth(<method>) : method
15584 Returns a method.
15585
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015586nbproc : integer
15587 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15588 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15589 and debugging purposes.
15590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015591nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15592 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15593 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15594 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015595 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15596 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15597 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015598
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015599prio_class : integer
15600 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15601 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15602 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15603
15604prio_offset : integer
15605 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15606 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15607 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15608 set-priority-offset".
15609
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015610proc : integer
15611 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15612 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15613 debugging purposes.
15614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015615queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015616 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15617 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15618 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15620 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15621 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15622 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15623 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15624
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015625rand([<range>]) : integer
15626 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15627 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15628 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15629 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15630 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15631
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015632uuid([<version>]) : string
15633 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15634 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15635 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15638 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15639 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15640 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15641 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15642 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015643 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15644 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15645
15646srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15647 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15648 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15649 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15650 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15651 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15652 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15653 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15654
15655 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15656 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657
15658srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15659 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15660 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15661 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015662 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015663 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15664 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15665 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15666
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015667srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15668 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15669 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15670 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15671 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15672 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15673 fetch methods.
15674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015675srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15676 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15677 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015678 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015679 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15680 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015681 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015682 overloading servers).
15683
15684 Example :
15685 # Redirect to a separate back
15686 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15687 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15688 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15689
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015690stopping : boolean
15691 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15692 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15693 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15694
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015695str(<string>) : string
15696 Returns a string.
15697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015698table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15699 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15700 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15701
15702table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15703 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15704 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15705 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15706
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015707thread : integer
15708 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15709 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15710 and debugging purposes.
15711
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015712var(<var-name>) : undefined
15713 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015714 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15715 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015716 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015717 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15718 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015719 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015720 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15721 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015722 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015723 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015724
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157257.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726----------------------------------
15727
15728The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15729closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15730methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15731sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15732TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015733the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15734counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015735"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15736used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15737can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15738Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15739table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15740tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15741currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015742
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015743bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015744 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15745 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15746 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015748be_id : integer
15749 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020015750 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
15751 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015752
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015753be_name : string
15754 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020015755 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
15756 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015758dst : ip
15759 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15760 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15761 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15762 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015763 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15764 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15765 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15766 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15767 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15768 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015769
15770dst_conn : integer
15771 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15772 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15773 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15774 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15775 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15776 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15777 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15778 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015779
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015780dst_is_local : boolean
15781 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15782 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15783 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15784 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015785 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015786 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15787 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15788 it only once per connection.
15789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015790dst_port : integer
15791 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15792 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15793 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15794 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15795 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15796 an HTTP header.
15797
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015798fc_http_major : integer
15799 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15800 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15801 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15802
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015803fc_pp_authority : string
15804 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15805 if any.
15806
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010015807fc_pp_unique_id : string
15808 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15809 if any.
15810
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015811fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15812 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15813 header.
15814
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015815fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15816 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15817 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15818 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15819 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15820 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15821 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15822
15823fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15824 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15825 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15826 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15827 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15828 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15829 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15830
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015831fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015832 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15833 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15834 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15835 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15836
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015837fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015838 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15839 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15840 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15841 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15842
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015843fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015844 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15845 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15846 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15847 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15848
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015849fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015850 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15851 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15852 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15853 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15854
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015855fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015856 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15857 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15858 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15859 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15860
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015861fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015862 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15863 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15864 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15865 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15866
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015867fe_defbe : string
15868 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15869 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871fe_id : integer
15872 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015873 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015874 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15875
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015876fe_name : string
15877 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15878 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15879 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15880
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015881sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015882sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15883sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15884sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015885 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15886 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15887 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15888
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015889sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015890sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15891sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15892sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015893 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15894 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15895 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15896
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015897sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015898sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15899sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15900sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015901 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15902 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015903 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15904 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15905 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015906
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015907 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015908 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15909 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015910 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15911 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15912 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015913 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15914 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15915
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015916sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15917sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15918sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15919sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15920 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15921 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15922 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15923 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15924 when a first ACL was verified.
15925
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015926sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015927sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15928sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15929sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015930 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015931 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15932
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015933sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015934sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15935sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15936sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015937 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15938 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15939 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15940
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015941sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015942sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15943sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15944sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015945 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15946 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15947 See also src_conn_rate.
15948
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015949sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015950sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15951sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15952sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015953 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015954 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015955
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015956sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15957sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15958sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15959sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15960 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15961 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15962
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015963sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15964sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15965sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15966sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15967 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15968 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15969
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015970sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015971sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15972sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15973sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015974 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15975 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15976 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015977 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15978 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15979 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015980
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015981sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15982sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15983sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15984sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15985 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15986 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15987 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15988 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15989 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15990 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15991
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015992sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015993sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15994sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15995sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015996 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015997 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15998 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15999
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016000sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016001sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16002sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16003sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016004 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16005 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16006 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16007 src_http_err_rate.
16008
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016009sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016010sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16011sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16012sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016013 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016014 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16015 src_http_req_cnt.
16016
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016017sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016018sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16019sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16020sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016021 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16022 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16023 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16024 src_http_req_rate.
16025
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016026sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016027sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16028sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16029sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016030 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016031 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16032 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16033 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16034 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016035
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016036 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016037 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16038 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016039 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16040
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016041sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16042sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16043sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16044sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16045 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16046 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16047 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16048 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16049 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16050
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016051sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016052sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16053sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16054sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016055 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16056 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16057 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016058
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016059sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016060sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16061sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16062sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016063 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16064 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16065 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016066
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016067sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016068sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16069sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16070sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016071 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016072 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16073 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16074 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016075 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016076 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16077
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016078sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016079sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16080sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16081sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016082 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16083 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16084 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16085 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16086 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016087 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016088
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016089sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016090sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16091sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16092sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016093 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16094 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16095 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16096
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016097sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016098sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16099sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16100sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016101 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16102 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016103 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016104 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16105 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016106 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16107 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16108 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016110so_id : integer
16111 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16112 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16113 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016114
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016115so_name : string
16116 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16117 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16118 strings instead of integers.
16119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016120src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016121 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016122 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16123 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16124 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016125 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16126 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16127 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016128 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16129 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16130 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16131 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16132 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16133 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16134 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016135
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016136 Example:
16137 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16138 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016140src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16141 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16142 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16143 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016144 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016146src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16147 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16148 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016149 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016150 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016152src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16153 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16154 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16155 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16156 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16157 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16158 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016159
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016160 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016161 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16162 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16163 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16164 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016165 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016166 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16167 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16168
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016169src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16170 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16171 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16172 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16173 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16174 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16175 was verified.
16176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016177src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016178 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016179 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016180 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016181 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016183src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016184 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016185 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16186 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016187 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016189src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16190 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16191 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16192 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016193 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016195src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016196 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016197 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016198 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016199 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016200
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016201src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16202 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16203 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16204 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16205 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16206
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016207src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16208 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16209 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16210 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16211 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016213src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016214 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016215 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016216 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16217 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016218 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16219 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16220 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016221
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016222src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16223 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16224 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16225 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16226 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16227 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16228 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16229 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016232 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016233 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016234 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016235 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016236 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016238src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16239 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16240 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16241 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16242 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016243 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016245src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016246 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016247 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16248 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016249 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016251src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16252 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16253 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16254 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016255 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016256 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016258src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16259 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16260 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16261 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016262 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016263 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16264 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016265
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016266 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016267 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016268 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016269 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016270
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016271src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16272 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16273 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16274 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16275 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16276 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16277 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16278
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016279src_is_local : boolean
16280 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16281 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16282 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16283 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016284 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016285 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16286 once per connection.
16287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016288src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016289 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16290 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16291 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16292 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16293 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016295src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016296 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16297 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16298 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16299 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16300 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016302src_port : integer
16303 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16304 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16305 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16306 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016308src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016309 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016310 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16311 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16312 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016313 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016315src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16316 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16317 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16318 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16319 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016320 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016322src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16323 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16324 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16325 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16326 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16327 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16328 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16329 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16330 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016331
16332 Example :
16333 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16334 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16335 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16336 listen ssh
16337 bind :22
16338 mode tcp
16339 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016340 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016341 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016342 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016344srv_id : integer
16345 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16346 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016347 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016348
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016349srv_name : string
16350 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16351 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016352 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016353
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163547.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016355----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016357The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16358closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16359when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16360usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016361future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016362
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001636351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16364 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16365 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16366 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16367 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16368 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16369
16370 Example :
16371 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16372 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16373 # the request.
16374 frontend http-in
16375 bind *:8081
16376 default_backend servers
16377 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16378 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16379
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016380ssl_bc : boolean
16381 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16382 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016383 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16384 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016385
16386ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16387 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016388 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16389 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016390
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016391ssl_bc_alpn : string
16392 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16393 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016394 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016395 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16396 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16397 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16398 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16399 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016400 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16401 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016402
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016403ssl_bc_cipher : string
16404 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016405 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16406 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016407
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016408ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16409 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16410 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16411 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016412 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016413
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016414ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16415 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16416 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016417 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16418 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016419
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016420ssl_bc_npn : string
16421 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16422 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016423 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016424 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16425 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16426 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16427 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016428 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
16429 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016430
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016431ssl_bc_protocol : string
16432 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016433 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16434 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016435
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016436ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016437 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016438 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016439 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
16440 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016441
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016442ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16443 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16444 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16445 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016446 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016447
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016448ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16449 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16450 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016451 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16452 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016453
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016454ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16455 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16456 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16457 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016458 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016459
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016460ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16461 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016462 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16463 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016465ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16466 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16467 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16468 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16469 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16470 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016472ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16473 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16474 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16475 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16476 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016477
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016478ssl_c_der : binary
16479 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16480 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16481 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016483ssl_c_err : integer
16484 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16485 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16486 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16487 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16488 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016489
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016490ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016491 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16492 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16493 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16494 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16495 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16496 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16497 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16498 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016499 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16500 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16501 LDAP v3.
16502 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16503 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016505ssl_c_key_alg : string
16506 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16507 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16508 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016510ssl_c_notafter : string
16511 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16512 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16513 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016515ssl_c_notbefore : string
16516 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16517 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16518 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016519
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016520ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016521 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16522 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16523 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16524 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16525 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16526 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16527 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16528 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016529 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16530 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16531 LDAP v3.
16532 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16533 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016535ssl_c_serial : binary
16536 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16537 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16538 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016540ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16541 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16542 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16543 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016544 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16545 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16546
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016547 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016548 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016550ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16551 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16552 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16553 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016555ssl_c_used : boolean
16556 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16557 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016559ssl_c_verify : integer
16560 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16561 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16562 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16563 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016565ssl_c_version : integer
16566 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16567 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016568
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016569ssl_f_der : binary
16570 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16571 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16572 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16573
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016574ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016575 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16576 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16577 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16578 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016579 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016580 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16581 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16582 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016583 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16584 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16585 LDAP v3.
16586 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16587 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016589ssl_f_key_alg : string
16590 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16591 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16592 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016594ssl_f_notafter : string
16595 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16596 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16597 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016599ssl_f_notbefore : string
16600 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16601 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16602 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016603
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016604ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016605 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16606 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16607 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16608 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16609 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16610 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16611 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16612 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016613 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16614 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16615 LDAP v3.
16616 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16617 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016619ssl_f_serial : binary
16620 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16621 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16622 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016623
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016624ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16625 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16626 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16627 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016629ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16630 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16631 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16632 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016634ssl_f_version : integer
16635 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16636 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16637
16638ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016639 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16640 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16641 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016643 Example :
16644 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16645 listen http-https
16646 bind :80
16647 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16648 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16649
16650ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16651 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16652 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16653
16654ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016655 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016656 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16657 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16658 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16659 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16660 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16661 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16662 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16663 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016665ssl_fc_cipher : string
16666 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16667 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016668
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016669ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16670 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16671 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016672 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016673
16674ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16675 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16676 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016677 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016678
16679ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16680 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16681 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16682 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016683 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016684 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016685
16686ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16687 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16688 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016689 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016690
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016691ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16692 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16693 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16694 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016696ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016697 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16698 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016699 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16700 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16701 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16702 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016703
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016704ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16705 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16706 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16707 wait until the handshake happened.
16708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016709ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16710 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016711 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16712 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016713 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016714 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016715
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016716ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016717 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016718 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16719 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016721ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016722 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016723 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16724 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16725 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16726 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16727 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16728 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16729 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016731ssl_fc_protocol : string
16732 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16733 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016734
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016735ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016736 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016737 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16738 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016739
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016740ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16741 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16742 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16743 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016745ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16746 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16747 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16748 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16749 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016750
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016751ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16752 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16753 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16754 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16755 BoringSSL.
16756
16757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016758ssl_fc_sni : string
16759 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16760 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16761 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16762 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16763 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16764
16765 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16766 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16767 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016768 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016769 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016771 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016772 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16773 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016775ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16776 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16777 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016778
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016779
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200167807.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016781------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016783Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16784sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16785only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16786For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16787be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16788can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16789sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16790for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16791content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016793payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016794 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016795 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16796 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016798payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16799 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016800 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016801 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016802
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016803req.hdrs : string
16804 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16805 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16806 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16807 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16808
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016809req.hdrs_bin : binary
16810 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16811 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16812 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16813 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16814 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16815 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16816
16817 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16818
16819 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16820 str: <int:length><bytes>
16821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016822req.len : integer
16823req_len : integer (deprecated)
16824 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16825 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16826 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16827 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16828 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16829 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16830 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16831 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016833req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16834 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016835 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16836 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16837 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16838 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016840 ACL alternatives :
16841 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016843req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16844 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16845 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16846 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16847 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016849 ACL alternatives :
16850 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016852 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016854req.proto_http : boolean
16855req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16856 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16857 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16858 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16859 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16860 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16861 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16862 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016864 Example:
16865 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16866 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16867 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016868 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016870req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16871rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16872 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16873 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16874 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16875 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16876 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16877 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16878 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016880 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16881 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16882 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16883 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16884 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16885 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016887 ACL derivatives :
16888 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016890 Example :
16891 listen tse-farm
16892 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16893 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16894 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16895 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16896 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16897 persist rdp-cookie
16898 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16899 # This is only useful makes sense if
16900 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16901 stick-table type string size 204800
16902 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16903 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16904 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016906 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16907 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016909req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16910rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16911 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16912 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16913 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16914 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016916 ACL derivatives :
16917 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016918
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016919req.ssl_alpn : string
16920 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16921 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16922 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16923 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16924 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16925 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016926 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016927
16928 Examples :
16929 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16930 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16931 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016932 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016933 default_backend bk_default
16934
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016935req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16936 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16937 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016938 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16939 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16940 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16941 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16942 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016944req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16945req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16946 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16947 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16948 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16949 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16950 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16951 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16952 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016954req.ssl_sni : string
16955req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16956 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16957 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16958 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16959 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16960 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16961 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16962 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16963 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16964 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16965 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16966 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16967 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016969 ACL derivatives :
16970 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016972 Examples :
16973 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16974 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16975 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16976 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16977 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016978
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016979req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16980 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16981 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16982 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16983 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16984 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16985 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16986 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16987 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16988 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016990req.ssl_ver : integer
16991req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16992 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16993 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16994 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16995 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16996 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16997 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16998 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016999 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017000 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017002 ACL derivatives :
17003 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017004
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017005res.len : integer
17006 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17007 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17008 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17009 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17010 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17011 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17012 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017013 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017015res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17016 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017017 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017018 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017019 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017020 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017022res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17023 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17024 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17025 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017026 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17027 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017029 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017030
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017031res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17032rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17033 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17034 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17035 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17036 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17037 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17038 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17039 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017041wait_end : boolean
17042 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17043 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017044 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017045 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17046 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017047 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017048 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17049 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017051 Examples :
17052 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17053 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17054 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017056 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17057 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17058 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17059 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17060 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17061 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17062 tcp-request content reject
17063
17064
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200170657.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017066--------------------------------------
17067
17068It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17069This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17070data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17071its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17072HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17073content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17074to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17075more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17076response are indexed.
17077
17078base : string
17079 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17080 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17081 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17082 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17083 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17084 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17085 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17086 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17087
17088 ACL derivatives :
17089 base : exact string match
17090 base_beg : prefix match
17091 base_dir : subdir match
17092 base_dom : domain match
17093 base_end : suffix match
17094 base_len : length match
17095 base_reg : regex match
17096 base_sub : substring match
17097
17098base32 : integer
17099 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17100 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17101 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017102 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17103 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17104 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017105
17106base32+src : binary
17107 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17108 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17109 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17110 per-URL counters.
17111
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017112capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17113 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17114 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17115 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17116
17117capture.req.method : string
17118 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17119 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17120 because it's allocated.
17121
17122capture.req.uri : string
17123 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17124 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17125 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17126 allocated.
17127
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017128capture.req.ver : string
17129 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17130 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17131 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17132
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017133capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17134 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17135 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17136 The first entry is an index of 0.
17137 See also: "capture response header"
17138
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017139capture.res.ver : string
17140 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17141 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17142 persistent flag.
17143
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017144req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017145 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17146 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17147 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017148
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017149req.body_param([<name>) : string
17150 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17151 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17152 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17153 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17154 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17155 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17156 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17157 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17158 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17159 given.
17160
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017161req.body_len : integer
17162 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17163 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017164 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17165 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017166
17167req.body_size : integer
17168 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017169 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17170 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017172req.cook([<name>]) : string
17173cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17174 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17175 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17176 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17177 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17178 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17179 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17180 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17181 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17182
17183 ACL derivatives :
17184 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17185 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17186 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17187 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17188 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17189 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17190 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17191 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017193req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17194cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17195 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17196 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017198req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17199cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17200 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17201 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17202 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17203 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017205cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17206 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17207 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17208 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17209 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017210 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017211 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17212 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17213 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17214 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017216hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17217 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17218 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17219 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17220 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017221 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017223req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17224 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17225 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17226 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17227 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17228 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17229 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17230 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17231 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017233req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17234 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17235 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17236 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17237 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017239req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17240 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17241 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17242 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17243 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17244 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17245 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17246 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17247 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017248 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017249 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017250 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017252 ACL derivatives :
17253 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17254 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17255 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17256 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17257 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17258 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17259 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17260 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17261
17262req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17263hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17264 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17265 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17266 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17267 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17268 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17269 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17270 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17271 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17272 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17273
17274req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17275hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17276 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17277 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17278 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17279 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17280 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017281 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017282 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17283 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17284
17285req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17286hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17287 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17288 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17289 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17290 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17291 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17292 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17293 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17294
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017295
17296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017297http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17298 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17299 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17300 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17301 basic auth is supported.
17302
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017303http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17304 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17305 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17306 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17307 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017308 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17309 basic auth is supported.
17310
17311 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017312 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17313 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17314 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17315 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017316
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017317http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017318 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17319 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17320 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017321
17322http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017323 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17324 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17325 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017326
17327http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017328 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17329 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17330 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017332http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017333 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17334 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017335 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17336 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017338method : integer + string
17339 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17340 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17341 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17342 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17343 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17344 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17345 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017347 ACL derivatives :
17348 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017350 Example :
17351 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17352 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17353 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017355path : string
17356 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17357 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17358 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17359 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17360 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017361 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017362 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017364 ACL derivatives :
17365 path : exact string match
17366 path_beg : prefix match
17367 path_dir : subdir match
17368 path_dom : domain match
17369 path_end : suffix match
17370 path_len : length match
17371 path_reg : regex match
17372 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017373
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017374query : string
17375 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17376 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17377 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17378 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017379 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017380 which stops before the question mark.
17381
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017382req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17383 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17384 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17385 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17386 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017388req.ver : string
17389req_ver : string (deprecated)
17390 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17391 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17392 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017394 ACL derivatives :
17395 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017396
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017397res.body : binary
17398 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
17399 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17400 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17401 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17402
17403res.body_len : integer
17404 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
17405 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17406 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17407 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17408
17409res.body_size : integer
17410 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
17411 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17412 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
17413 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
17414 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
17415 based expect rules.
17416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017417res.comp : boolean
17418 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17419 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17420 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017422res.comp_algo : string
17423 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17424 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17425 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017427res.cook([<name>]) : string
17428scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17429 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17430 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017431 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
17432 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017434 ACL derivatives :
17435 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017437res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17438scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17439 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17440 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017441 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
17442 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017444res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17445scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17446 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17447 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017448 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
17449 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017451res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17452 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17453 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17454 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17455 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17456 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17457 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17458 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17459 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017460 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017462res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17463 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17464 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17465 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17466 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017467 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
17468 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017470res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17471shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17472 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17473 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17474 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17475 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17476 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17477 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17478 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017479 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
17480 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017482 ACL derivatives :
17483 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17484 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17485 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17486 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17487 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17488 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17489 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17490 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17491
17492res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17493shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17494 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17495 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17496 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17497 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017498 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017500res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17501shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17502 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17503 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17504 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17505 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17506 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017507 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
17508 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017509
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017510res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17511 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17512 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17513 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017514 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
17515 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017517res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17518shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17519 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17520 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17521 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17522 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17523 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017524 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
17525 based expect rules.
17526
17527res.hdrs : string
17528 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
17529 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17530 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17531 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
17532 based expect rules.
17533
17534res.hdrs_bin : binary
17535 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17536 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
17537 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
17538 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
17539 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
17540 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
17541 (length of 0 for both).
17542
17543 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17544
17545 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17546 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017548res.ver : string
17549resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17550 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017551 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
17552 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017554 ACL derivatives :
17555 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017557set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17558 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17559 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017560 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017561 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017563 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17564 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017566status : integer
17567 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17568 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017569 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
17570 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017571
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017572unique-id : string
17573 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17574 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17575 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17576 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17577 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17578 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017580url : string
17581 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17582 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17583 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17584 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17585 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17586 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17587 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017589 ACL derivatives :
17590 url : exact string match
17591 url_beg : prefix match
17592 url_dir : subdir match
17593 url_dom : domain match
17594 url_end : suffix match
17595 url_len : length match
17596 url_reg : regex match
17597 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017599url_ip : ip
17600 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17601 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17602 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17603 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17604 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17605 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17606 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017608url_port : integer
17609 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17610 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17611 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17612 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017613
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017614urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17615url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017616 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
17617 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017618 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
17619 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
17620 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
17621 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017622 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
17623 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017624 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
17625 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017627 ACL derivatives :
17628 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
17629 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
17630 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
17631 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
17632 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
17633 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
17634 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
17635 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017636
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017638 Example :
17639 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
17640 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
17641 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
17642 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017643
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017644urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017645 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
17646 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17647 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017648
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017649url32 : integer
17650 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17651 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17652 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17653 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17654 is an unsigned integer.
17655
17656url32+src : binary
17657 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17658 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17659 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17660
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020017661
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200176627.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017663---------------------------------------
17664
17665This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17666used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17667purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17668There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17669or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17670any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17671for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17672
17673internal.htx.data : integer
17674 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17675 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17676
17677internal.htx.free : integer
17678 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17679 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17680
17681internal.htx.free_data : integer
17682 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17683 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17684
17685internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17686 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17687 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17688 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17689
17690internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17691 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17692 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17693
17694internal.htx.size : integer
17695 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17696 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17697
17698internal.htx.used : integer
17699 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17700 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17701 direction.
17702
17703internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17704 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17705 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17706 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17707 of the special value :
17708 * head : The oldest inserted block
17709 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017710 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017711
17712internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17713 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17714 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17715 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17716 integer or one of the special value :
17717 * head : The oldest inserted block
17718 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017719 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017720
17721internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17722 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17723 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17724 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17725 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17726
17727 * head : The oldest inserted block
17728 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017729 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017730
17731internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17732 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17733 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17734 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17735 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17736
17737 * head : The oldest inserted block
17738 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017739 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017740
17741internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17742 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17743 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17744 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17745 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17746
17747 * head : The oldest inserted block
17748 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017749 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017750
17751internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17752 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17753 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17754 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17755 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17756
17757 * head : The oldest inserted block
17758 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017759 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017760
17761internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17762 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17763 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17764 it returns false.
17765
17766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200177677.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017768---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017770Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17771every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017772order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017774ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17775---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017776FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017777HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017778HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17779HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017780HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17781HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17782HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17783HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17784LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017785METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017786METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017787METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17788METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17789METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17790METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017791METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017792METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017793RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017794REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017795TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017796WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17797---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017798
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178008. Logging
17801----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017802
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017803One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17804provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17805very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17806provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17807state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017808to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017809headers.
17810
17811In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17812about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17813send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17814
17815 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17816 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17817 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17818 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17819 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017820 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017821 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017822
17823The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17824allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17825as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17826while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17827real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17828delay.
17829
17830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178318.1. Log levels
17832---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017833
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017834TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017835source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017836HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17837in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17838track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17839syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17840about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017841
17842
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178438.2. Log formats
17844----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017845
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017846HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017847and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17848slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17849options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017850
17851 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17852 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17853 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17854 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17855 extents.
17856
17857 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17858 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17859 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17860 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17861 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17862
17863 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17864 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17865 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17866 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17867 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17868
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017869 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17870 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17871 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17872 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17873
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017874 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17875
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017876Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17877specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17878field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17879servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17880always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17881identifier.
17882
17883Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17884 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17885 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17886 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17887 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17888
17889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178908.2.1. Default log format
17891-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017892
17893This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17894as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17895format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17896
17897 Example :
17898 listen www
17899 mode http
17900 log global
17901 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17902
17903 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17904 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17905 (www/HTTP)
17906
17907 Field Format Extract from the example above
17908 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17909 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17910 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17911 4 'to' to
17912 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17913 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17914
17915Detailed fields description :
17916 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17917 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17918 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17919 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17920 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17921 and processed the connection.
17922 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17923
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017924In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17925"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17926connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17927
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017928It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17929will eventually disappear.
17930
17931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179328.2.2. TCP log format
17933---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017934
17935The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17936is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17937information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17938counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17939emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17940environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17941the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17942sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017943specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17944not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17945fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17946marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017947
17948 Example :
17949 frontend fnt
17950 mode tcp
17951 option tcplog
17952 log global
17953 default_backend bck
17954
17955 backend bck
17956 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17957
17958 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17959 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17960 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17961
17962 Field Format Extract from the example above
17963 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17964 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17965 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17966 4 frontend_name fnt
17967 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17968 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17969 7 bytes_read* 212
17970 8 termination_state --
17971 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17972 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17973
17974Detailed fields description :
17975 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017976 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17977 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17978 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017979 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017980 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017981 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017982
17983 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017984 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17985 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17986 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017987
17988 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17989 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17990 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017991 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17992 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17993 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17994 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017995
17996 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17997 and processed the connection.
17998
17999 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18000 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18001 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18002 applications.
18003
18004 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18005 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18006 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18007 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18008 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18009
18010 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18011 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18012 See "Timers" below for more details.
18013
18014 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18015 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18016 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18017 "Timers" below for more details.
18018
18019 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018020 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018021 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18022 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18023 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18024 details.
18025
18026 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18027 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18028 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18029 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18030 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18031
18032 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18033 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18034 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18035 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18036 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18037 for more details.
18038
18039 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018040 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018041 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18042 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18043 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018044 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018045
18046 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18047 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18048 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18049 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18050 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18051 caused by a denial of service attack.
18052
18053 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18054 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18055 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18056 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18057 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18058 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18059 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18060 denial of service attack.
18061
18062 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18063 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18064 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18065 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18066 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18067 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18068 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18069 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18070 be processed than on other servers.
18071
18072 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18073 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18074 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18075 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18076 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18077 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18078 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18079 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18080 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18081 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18082 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18083 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18084 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18085
18086 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18087 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18088 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18089 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18090 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18091 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018092 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018093 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18094
18095 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18096 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18097 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18098 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18099 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18100 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018101 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018102 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18103 occurs.
18104
18105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181068.2.3. HTTP log format
18107----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018108
18109The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18110is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18111the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18112are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18113emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18114generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18115"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18116which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018117frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18118is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018119
18120Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18121slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18122with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18123
18124 Example :
18125 frontend http-in
18126 mode http
18127 option httplog
18128 log global
18129 default_backend bck
18130
18131 backend static
18132 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18133
18134 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18135 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18136 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018137 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018138
18139 Field Format Extract from the example above
18140 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18141 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018142 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018143 4 frontend_name http-in
18144 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018145 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018146 7 status_code 200
18147 8 bytes_read* 2750
18148 9 captured_request_cookie -
18149 10 captured_response_cookie -
18150 11 termination_state ----
18151 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18152 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18153 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18154 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18155 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018156
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018157Detailed fields description :
18158 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018159 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18160 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18161 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018162 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018163 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018164 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018165
18166 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018167 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18168 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18169 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018170
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018171 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18172 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018173
18174 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18175 and processed the connection.
18176
18177 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18178 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18179 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18180
18181 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18182 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18183 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18184 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18185 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18186 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18187
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018188 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18189 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18190 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018191 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018192 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18193 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018194 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18195 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018196
18197 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18198 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018199 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018200
18201 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18202 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018203 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18204 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018205
18206 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18207 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18208 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18209 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18210 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018211 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18212 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018213
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018214 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18215 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18216 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18217 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18218 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18219 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18220 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018221 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018222
18223 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18224 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18225 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18226
18227 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18228 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018229 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018230 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18231 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18232 overflowing.
18233
18234 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18235 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18236 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18237 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18238 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18239 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18240 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18241 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18242
18243 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18244 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18245 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18246 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18247 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18248 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18249 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18250 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18251
18252 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18253 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18254 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18255 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18256 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18257 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18258 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18259
18260 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018261 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018262 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18263 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18264 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018265 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018266 system.
18267
18268 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18269 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18270 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18271 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18272 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18273 caused by a denial of service attack.
18274
18275 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18276 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18277 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18278 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18279 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18280 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18281 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18282 denial of service attack.
18283
18284 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18285 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18286 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18287 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18288 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18289 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18290 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18291 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18292 processed than on other servers.
18293
18294 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18295 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18296 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18297 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18298 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18299 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18300 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18301 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18302 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18303 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18304 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18305 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18306 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18307
18308 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18309 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18310 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18311 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18312 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18313 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018314 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018315 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18316
18317 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18318 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18319 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18320 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18321 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18322 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018323 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018324 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18325 occurs.
18326
18327 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18328 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18329 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18330 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18331 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18332 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18333 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18334 cookies" below for more details.
18335
18336 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18337 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18338 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18339 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18340 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18341 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18342 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18343 and cookies" below for more details.
18344
18345 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18346 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18347 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18348 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18349 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18350 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18351 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18352 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18353
18354
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200183558.2.4. Custom log format
18356------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018357
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018358The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018359mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018361HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018362Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18363separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18364prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18365
18366Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18367variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018368("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018369
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018370If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018371as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018372less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18373the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18374
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018375Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018376In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010018377in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018378
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018379Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18380'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18381https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18382such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18383
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018384Flags are :
18385 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018386 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018387 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18388 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018389
18390 Example:
18391
18392 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18393 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18394
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018395 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18396
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018397At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18398
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018399 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18400 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018401
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018402the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018403
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018404 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18405 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18406 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018407
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018408and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18409
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018410 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18411 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018412
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018413Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18414
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018415 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018416 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018417 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18418 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18419 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018420 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18421 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18422 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018423 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018424 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18425 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018426 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018427 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18428 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018429 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018430 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018431 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018432 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018433 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018434 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018435 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018436 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18437 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18438 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18439 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18440 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018441 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018442 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018443 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018444 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018445 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018446 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18447 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018448 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18449 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18450 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018451 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018452 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18453 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018454 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018455 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18456 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18457 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018458 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018459 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018460 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18461 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18462 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18463 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018464 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018465 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018466 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018467 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018468 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018469 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018470 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18471 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18472 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018473 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018474 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18475 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018476 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018477 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18478 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018479 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018480 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018481 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018482 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018483
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018484 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018485
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018486
184878.2.5. Error log format
18488-----------------------
18489
18490When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18491protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18492By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18493"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018494will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018495logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18496
18497The format looks like this :
18498
18499 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18500 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18501 Connection error during SSL handshake
18502
18503 Field Format Extract from the example above
18504 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18505 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18506 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18507 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18508 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18509
18510These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18511failures.
18512
18513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185148.3. Advanced logging options
18515-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018516
18517Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18518just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18519options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18520for more information about their usage.
18521
18522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185238.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18524------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018525
18526It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18527haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18528commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18529monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18530ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18531
18532 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18533 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18534 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18535 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18536
18537 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18538 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18539 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018540 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018541 such as other load-balancers.
18542
18543 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18544 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18545 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18546
18547
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185488.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18549----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018550
18551The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18552what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18553or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018554"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018555just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18556log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18557after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18558is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18559with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18560with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18561
18562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185638.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18564------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018565
18566Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18567for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18568"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18569retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18570raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18571a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18572file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18573you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18574"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18575
18576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185778.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18578--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018579
18580Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18581multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18582them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18583"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18584logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18585error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18586and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18587too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18588useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18589alternative.
18590
18591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185928.4. Timing events
18593------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018594
18595Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18596reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18597the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18598frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018599mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18600addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18601
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018602Timings events in HTTP mode:
18603
18604 first request 2nd request
18605 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18606 t tr t tr ...
18607 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18608 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18609 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18610 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018611 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018612 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18613
18614Timings events in TCP mode:
18615
18616 TCP session
18617 |<----------------->|
18618 t t
18619 ---|----|----|----|----|---
18620 | Th Tw Tc Td |
18621 |<------ Tt ------->|
18622
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018623 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018624 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018625 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
18626 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
18627 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018628 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018629 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
18630 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
18631 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
18632 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018633
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018634 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
18635 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
18636 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018637 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
18638 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
18639 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
18640 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
18641 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
18642 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018643
18644 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
18645 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
18646 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
18647 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
18648 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
18649 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
18650 request typed by hand during a test.
18651
18652 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18653 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018654 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018655 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18656 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18657 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18658 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018659
18660 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18661 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18662 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18663 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18664 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18665
18666 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18667 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18668 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18669 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18670 connection never established.
18671
18672 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18673 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18674 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18675 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18676 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18677 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18678 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18679 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18680 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18681 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18682 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18683
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018684 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18685 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18686 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18687 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18688 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18689 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18690
18691 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18692
18693 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18694 "Ta" can never be negative.
18695
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018696 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18697 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018698 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18699 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018700 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018701
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018702 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018703
18704 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018705 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18706 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018707
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018708 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
18709 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
18710 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
18711 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
18712 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
18713 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
18714 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
18715 prefixed with a '+' sign.
18716
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018717These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18718protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18719that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018720due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18721"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18722that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018723
18724Most common cases :
18725
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018726 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18727 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18728 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18729 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18730 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18731 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18732 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18733 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18734 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18735 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18736 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018737 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018738
18739 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18740 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18741 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18742 of ms on remote networks.
18743
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018744 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18745 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18746 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018747
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018748 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18749 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18750 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18751 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18752 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18753 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18754 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18755 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18756 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018757
18758Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18759
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018760 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018761 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018762 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018763
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018764 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018765 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18766 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18767
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018768 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018769 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18770 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18771 flags.
18772
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018773 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18774 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018775 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18776 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18777 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18778 the client connection was maintained open.
18779
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018780 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018781 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018782 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018783 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18784
18785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187868.5. Session state at disconnection
18787-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018788
18789TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18790"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
187912-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18792each of which has a special meaning :
18793
18794 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18795 session to terminate :
18796
18797 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18798
18799 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18800 server explicitly refused it.
18801
18802 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18803 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18804 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18805 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018806 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018807
18808 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18809 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018810
18811 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18812 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18813 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18814 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18815 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18816
18817 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18818 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18819 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18820 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18821 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18822
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018823 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18824 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18825
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018826 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18827 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18828 backup connections when going up.
18829
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018830 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18831
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018832 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18833 send or receive data.
18834
18835 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18836 send or receive data.
18837
18838 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18839 with nothing left in the buffers.
18840
18841 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18842
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018843 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018844 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18845
18846 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18847 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18848 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18849 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18850 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18851
18852 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18853 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18854
18855 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18856 server (HTTP only).
18857
18858 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18859
18860 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18861 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18862 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18863
18864 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18865 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18866 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18867
18868 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18869
18870 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18871 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18872
18873 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18874 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18875 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18876
18877 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18878 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018879 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18880 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018881
18882 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18883 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18884 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18885 another server.
18886
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018887 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018888 server.
18889
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018890 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18891 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18892 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18893 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18894
18895 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18896 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18897 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18898 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18899
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018900 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18901 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18902 "use-server" rule).
18903
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018904 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18905
18906 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18907 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18908
18909 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18910
18911 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18912 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18913 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18914
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018915 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18916 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018917 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018918 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18919 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18920
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018921 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18922
18923 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18924 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18925
18926 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18927
18928 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18929
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018930The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18931was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018932helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18933starvation, attacks, etc...
18934
18935The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18936alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18937easier finding and understanding.
18938
18939 Flags Reason
18940
18941 -- Normal termination.
18942
18943 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18944 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18945 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18946 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18947
18948 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18949 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18950 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18951 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18952 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18953 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018954
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018955 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18956 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018957 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018958
18959 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18960 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18961 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18962
18963 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18964 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18965 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18966 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18967 the server takes too long to respond.
18968
18969 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18970 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18971 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18972 long a time to respond.
18973
18974 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18975 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18976 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18977 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018978 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18979 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018980
18981 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18982 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18983 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18984 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18985 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018986 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018987 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18988 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18989 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18990 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18991 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18992 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18993 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18994 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018995 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018996 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18997 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18998 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018999
19000 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19001 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019002 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19003 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19004 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19005 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019006
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019007 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19008 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019010 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019011 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19012 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019013 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019014 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19015 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19016
19017 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19018 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19019 503 or 504 here.
19020
19021 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19022 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19023 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19024 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19025 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19026
19027 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19028 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019029 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019030 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19031 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19032
19033 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19034 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19035 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19036 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19037 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19038 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19039 between haproxy and the server.
19040
19041 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19042 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19043 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19044 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19045 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19046 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19047 solution is to fix the application.
19048
19049 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19050 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19051 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19052 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19053 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19054 external attacks.
19055
19056 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19057 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019058 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019059 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19060 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19061
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019062 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19063 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19064 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019065 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019066 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019067
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019068 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19069 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19070 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19071 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019072 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19073 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19074 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19075 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19076 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019077
19078 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19079 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19080 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19081 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19082
19083 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19084 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19085 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19086 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19087
19088 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19089 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19090 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19091 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19092
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019093The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19094persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19095important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19096re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19097
19098 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19099
19100 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19101 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19102 set on a GET request.
19103
19104 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19105 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019106 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019107 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19108
19109 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19110 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19111 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19112
19113 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19114 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19115 already got a cookie.
19116
19117 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19118 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19119 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19120 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19121 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19122
19123 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19124 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19125 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19126
19127 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19128 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19129 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19130
19131 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19132 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19133
19134 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19135 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19136 then advertised in the response.
19137
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191398.6. Non-printable characters
19140-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019141
19142In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19143consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19144converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19145prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19146being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19147escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19148is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19149'}' when logging headers.
19150
19151Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19152issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19153containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19154
19155Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19156the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19157performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19158
19159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191608.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19161---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019162
19163Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19164achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019165section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019166cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19167the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19168the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019169locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019170not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19171user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19172a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19173wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19174
19175 Examples :
19176 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19177 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19178
19179 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19180 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19181
19182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191838.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19184---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019185
19186Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19187proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19188the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19189server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19190
19191Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19192response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019193section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019194
19195It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019196time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19197appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019198are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19199and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19200follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19201request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19202in the logs.
19203
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019204As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19205frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19206an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19207
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019208 Example :
19209 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19210 listen proxy-out
19211 mode http
19212 option httplog
19213 option logasap
19214 log global
19215 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19216
19217 # log the name of the virtual server
19218 capture request header Host len 20
19219
19220 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19221 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19222
19223 # log the beginning of the referrer
19224 capture request header Referer len 20
19225
19226 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19227 capture response header Server len 20
19228
19229 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19230 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19231
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019232 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019233 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19234
19235 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19236 capture response header Via len 20
19237
19238 # log the URL location during a redirection
19239 capture response header Location len 20
19240
19241 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19242 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19243 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19244 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19245 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19246
19247 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19248 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19249 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19250 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019251 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019252
19253 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19254 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19255 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19256 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19257 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019258 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019259
19260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192618.9. Examples of logs
19262---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019263
19264These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19265them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19266reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19267
19268 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19269 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19270 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19271
19272 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19273 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19274
19275 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19276 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19277 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19278
19279 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19280 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19281
19282 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19283 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19284 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19285
19286 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019287 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019288 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19289 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19290
19291 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19292 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19293 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19294
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019295 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19296 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19297 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19298 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19299 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19300 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019301
19302 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019303 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019304
19305 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19306 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19307 Nothing was sent to any server.
19308
19309 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19310 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19311
19312 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19313 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019314 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019315 send a 408 return code to the client.
19316
19317 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19318 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19319
19320 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19321 5 seconds ("c----").
19322
19323 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19324 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019325 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019326
19327 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019328 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019329 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19330 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19331 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19332 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19333 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019334
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019335
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200193369. Supported filters
19337--------------------
19338
19339Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19340accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19341unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19342
19343See also : "filter"
19344
193459.1. Trace
19346----------
19347
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019348filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019349
19350 Arguments:
19351 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19352 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19353
19354 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19355 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19356 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19357 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19358
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019359 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019360 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19361 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19362 amount of the parsed data.
19363
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019364 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019365
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019366This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19367callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19368information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19369filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19370
19371Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19372tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19373a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19374
19375
193769.2. HTTP compression
19377---------------------
19378
19379filter compression
19380
19381The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19382keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019383when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19384fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19385done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19386explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19387filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19388listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19389order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019390
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019391See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19392 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019393
19394
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200193959.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19396--------------------------------------------
19397
19398filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19399
19400 Arguments :
19401
19402 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19403 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19404 parsed.
19405
19406 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19407 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19408 part must be placed in its own scope.
19409
19410The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19411external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019412streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019413exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19414also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19415
19416SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19417the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19418
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019419For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019420"doc/SPOE.txt".
19421
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100194229.4. Cache
19423----------
19424
19425filter cache <name>
19426
19427 Arguments :
19428
19429 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19430
19431The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19432"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019433cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019434other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19435case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19436is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19437filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019438listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19439order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019440
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019441See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19442 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19443
19444
194459.5. Fcgi-app
19446-------------
19447
19448filter fcg-app <name>
19449
19450 Arguments :
19451
19452 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19453
19454The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19455request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19456reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19457used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19458implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19459used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19460fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19461used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19462order.
19463
19464See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19465 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19466
19467
1946810. FastCGI applications
19469-------------------------
19470
19471HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19472feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19473the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19474FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19475servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19476FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19477backend.
19478
19479HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19480application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19481connection.
19482
1948310.1. Setup
19484-----------
19485
1948610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19487--------------------------
19488
19489fcgi-app <name>
19490 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19491 document root must be defined.
19492
19493acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19494 Declare or complete an access list.
19495
19496 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19497 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19498 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19499 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19500 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19501
19502docroot <path>
19503 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19504 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19505 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19506
19507index <script-name>
19508 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19509 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19510 is an optional setting.
19511
19512 Example :
19513 index index.php
19514
19515log-stderr global
19516log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19517 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19518 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19519
19520 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19521 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19522
19523pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19524 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19525 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19526 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19527
19528 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19529 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19530 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19531 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19532
19533 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19534 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19535
19536path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019537 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019538 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19539 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19540 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19541 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19542 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19543 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19544 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019545
19546 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019547 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019548 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19549 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19550 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19551 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019552
19553 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019554 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19555 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019556
19557option get-values
19558no option get-values
19559 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19560
19561 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19562 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19563
19564 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19565 application will accept.
19566
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019567 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19568 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019569
19570 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
19571 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
19572 option is disabled.
19573
19574 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19575 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19576 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19577 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19578 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19579 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19580
19581option keep-conn
19582no option keep-conn
19583 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19584 sending a response.
19585
19586 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19587 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19588
19589option max-reqs <reqs>
19590 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19591 accept.
19592
19593 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19594 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19595 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19596 to 1.
19597
19598option mpxs-conns
19599no option mpxs-conns
19600 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19601
19602 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19603 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19604
19605set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19606 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19607 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19608 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19609 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19610
19611 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19612 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19613 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19614
19615 Example :
19616 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
19617 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
19618
19619 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
19620
19621
1962210.1.2. Proxy section
19623---------------------
19624
19625use-fcgi-app <name>
19626 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
19627
19628 Arguments :
19629 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
19630
19631 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
19632 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
19633 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
19634 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
19635 application may be defined at a time per backend.
19636
19637 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
19638 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
19639 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
19640 application are evaluated.
19641
19642
1964310.1.3. Example
19644---------------
19645
19646 frontend front-http
19647 mode http
19648 bind *:80
19649 bind *:
19650
19651 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
19652 default_backend back-static
19653
19654 backend back-static
19655 mode http
19656 server www A.B.C.D:80
19657
19658 backend back-dynamic
19659 mode http
19660 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19661 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19662
19663 fcgi-app php-fpm
19664 log-stderr global
19665 option keep-conn
19666
19667 docroot /var/www/my-app
19668 index index.php
19669 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19670
19671
1967210.2. Default parameters
19673------------------------
19674
19675A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19676the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019677script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019678applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19679
19680 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19681 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19682 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19683 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19684 | | |
19685 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19686 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19687 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19688 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19689 | | application. |
19690 | | |
19691 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19692 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19693 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19694 | | |
19695 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19696 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19697 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19698 | | the application's configuration. |
19699 | | |
19700 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19701 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19702 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19703 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19704 | | |
19705 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19706 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19707 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19708 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19709 | | be defined. |
19710 | | |
19711 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19712 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19713 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19714 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19715 | | is not set too. |
19716 | | |
19717 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19718 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19719 | | set. |
19720 | | |
19721 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19722 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19723 | | the request. |
19724 | | |
19725 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19726 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19727 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19728 | | |
19729 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19730 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19731 | | script to process the request. |
19732 | | |
19733 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19734 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19735 | | |
19736 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19737 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19738 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19739 | | |
19740 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19741 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19742 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19743 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19744 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19745 | | |
19746 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19747 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19748 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19749 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19750 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19751 | | side. |
19752 | | |
19753 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19754 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19755 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19756 | | connected to. |
19757 | | |
19758 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19759 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19760 | | |
19761 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19762 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19763 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19764 | | |
19765 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19766
19767
1976810.3. Limitations
19769------------------
19770
19771The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19772way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19773during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19774establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19775application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19776or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19777message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19778these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19779and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19780
19781Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19782request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19783requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19784
19785About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19786into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19787fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19788"http-request" ones.
19789
19790Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19791FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19792processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19793must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19794here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019795
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019796/*
19797 * Local variables:
19798 * fill-column: 79
19799 * End:
19800 */